14531 lines
575 KiB
Plaintext
14531 lines
575 KiB
Plaintext
|
|
\input texinfo
|
|
@c %**start of header
|
|
@setfilename ../../info/org
|
|
@settitle The Org Manual
|
|
|
|
@set VERSION 7.01trans
|
|
@set DATE July 2010
|
|
|
|
@c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
|
|
@c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
|
|
@set txicodequoteundirected
|
|
@set txicodequotebacktick
|
|
|
|
@c Version and Contact Info
|
|
@set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
|
|
@set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
|
|
@set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
|
|
@set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
|
|
@set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
|
|
@c %**end of header
|
|
@finalout
|
|
|
|
@c Macro definitions
|
|
@iftex
|
|
@c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
|
|
@end iftex
|
|
@macro Ie {}
|
|
I.e.,
|
|
@end macro
|
|
@macro ie {}
|
|
i.e.,
|
|
@end macro
|
|
@macro Eg {}
|
|
E.g.,
|
|
@end macro
|
|
@macro eg {}
|
|
e.g.,
|
|
@end macro
|
|
|
|
@c Subheadings inside a table.
|
|
@macro tsubheading{text}
|
|
@ifinfo
|
|
@subsubheading \text\
|
|
@end ifinfo
|
|
@ifnotinfo
|
|
@item @b{\text\}
|
|
@end ifnotinfo
|
|
@end macro
|
|
|
|
@copying
|
|
This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
|
|
|
|
Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation
|
|
|
|
@quotation
|
|
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
|
|
under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
|
|
any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
|
|
Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
|
|
and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
|
|
is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
|
|
|
|
(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
|
|
modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
|
|
developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
|
|
|
|
This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
|
|
Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
|
|
separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
|
|
license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
@end copying
|
|
|
|
@dircategory Emacs
|
|
@direntry
|
|
* Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
|
|
@end direntry
|
|
|
|
@titlepage
|
|
@title The Org Manual
|
|
|
|
@subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
|
|
@author by Carsten Dominik
|
|
with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, and Thomas Dye
|
|
|
|
@c The following two commands start the copyright page.
|
|
@page
|
|
@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
|
|
@insertcopying
|
|
@end titlepage
|
|
|
|
@c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
|
|
@contents
|
|
|
|
@ifnottex
|
|
@node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
|
|
@top Org Mode Manual
|
|
|
|
@insertcopying
|
|
@end ifnottex
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Introduction:: Getting started
|
|
* Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
|
|
* Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
|
|
* Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
|
|
* TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
|
|
* Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
|
|
* Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
|
|
* Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
|
|
* Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
|
|
* Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
|
|
* Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
|
|
* Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
|
|
* Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
|
|
* Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
|
|
* Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
|
|
* Hacking:: How to hack your way around
|
|
* MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
|
|
* History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
|
|
* Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
|
|
* Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
|
|
* Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
|
|
|
|
@detailmenu
|
|
--- The Detailed Node Listing ---
|
|
|
|
Introduction
|
|
|
|
* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
|
|
* Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
|
|
* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
|
|
* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
|
|
* Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
|
|
|
|
Document structure
|
|
|
|
* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
|
|
* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
|
|
* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
|
|
* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
|
|
* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
|
|
* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
|
|
* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
|
|
* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
|
|
* Blocks:: Folding blocks
|
|
* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
|
|
* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
|
|
|
|
Tables
|
|
|
|
* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
|
|
* Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
|
|
* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
|
|
* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
|
|
* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
|
|
* Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
|
|
|
|
The spreadsheet
|
|
|
|
* References:: How to refer to another field or range
|
|
* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
|
|
* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
|
|
* Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
|
|
* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
|
|
* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
|
|
* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
|
|
* Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
|
|
|
|
Hyperlinks
|
|
|
|
* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
|
|
* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
|
|
* External links:: URL-like links to the world
|
|
* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
|
|
* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
|
|
* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
|
|
* Search options:: Linking to a specific location
|
|
* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
|
|
|
|
Internal links
|
|
|
|
* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
|
|
|
|
TODO items
|
|
|
|
* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
|
|
* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
|
|
* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
|
|
* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
|
|
* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
|
|
* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
|
|
|
|
Extended use of TODO keywords
|
|
|
|
* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
|
|
* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
|
|
* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
|
|
* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
|
|
* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
|
|
* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
|
|
* TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
|
|
|
|
Progress logging
|
|
|
|
* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
|
|
* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
|
|
* Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
|
|
|
|
Tags
|
|
|
|
* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
|
|
* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
|
|
* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
|
|
|
|
Properties and columns
|
|
|
|
* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
|
|
* Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
|
|
* Property searches:: Matching property values
|
|
* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
|
|
* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
|
|
* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
|
|
|
|
Column view
|
|
|
|
* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
|
|
* Using column view:: How to create and use column view
|
|
* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
|
|
|
|
Defining columns
|
|
|
|
* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
|
|
* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
|
|
|
|
Dates and times
|
|
|
|
* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
|
|
* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
|
|
* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
|
|
* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
|
|
* Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
|
|
* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
|
|
* Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
|
|
|
|
Creating timestamps
|
|
|
|
* The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
|
|
* Custom time format:: Making dates look different
|
|
|
|
Deadlines and scheduling
|
|
|
|
* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
|
|
* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
|
|
|
|
Capture - Refile - Archive
|
|
|
|
* Capture:: Capturing new stuff
|
|
* Attachments:: Add files to tasks
|
|
* RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
|
|
* Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
|
|
* Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
|
|
* Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
|
|
|
|
Capture
|
|
|
|
* Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
|
|
* Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
|
|
* Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
|
|
|
|
Capture templates
|
|
|
|
* Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
|
|
* Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
|
|
|
|
Archiving
|
|
|
|
* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
|
|
* Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
|
|
|
|
Agenda views
|
|
|
|
* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
|
|
* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
|
|
* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
|
|
* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
|
|
* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
|
|
* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
|
|
* Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
|
|
* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
|
|
|
|
The built-in agenda views
|
|
|
|
* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
|
|
* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
|
|
* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
|
|
* Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
|
|
* Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
|
|
* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
|
|
|
|
Presentation and sorting
|
|
|
|
* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
|
|
* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
|
|
* Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
|
|
|
|
Custom agenda views
|
|
|
|
* Storing searches:: Type once, use often
|
|
* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
|
|
* Setting Options:: Changing the rules
|
|
|
|
Markup for rich export
|
|
|
|
* Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
|
|
* Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
|
|
* Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
|
|
* Include files:: Include additional files into a document
|
|
* Index entries:: Making an index
|
|
* Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
|
|
* Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
|
|
|
|
Structural markup elements
|
|
|
|
* Document title:: Where the title is taken from
|
|
* Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
|
|
* Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
|
|
* Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
|
|
* Lists:: Lists
|
|
* Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
|
|
* Footnote markup:: Footnotes
|
|
* Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
|
|
* Horizontal rules:: Make a line
|
|
* Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
|
|
|
|
Embedded La@TeX{}
|
|
|
|
* Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
|
|
* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
|
|
* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
|
|
* Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
|
|
* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
|
|
|
|
Exporting
|
|
|
|
* Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
|
|
* Export options:: Per-file export settings
|
|
* The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
|
|
* ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
|
|
* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
|
|
* LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
|
|
* DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
|
|
* TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
|
|
* Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
|
|
* XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
|
|
* iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
|
|
|
|
HTML export
|
|
|
|
* HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
|
|
* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
|
|
* Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
|
|
* Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
|
|
* Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
|
|
* Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
|
|
* CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
|
|
* JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
|
|
|
|
La@TeX{} and PDF export
|
|
|
|
* LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
|
|
* Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
|
|
* Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
|
|
* Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
|
|
* Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
|
|
* Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
|
|
|
|
DocBook export
|
|
|
|
* DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
|
|
* Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
|
|
* Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
|
|
* Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
|
|
* Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
|
|
* Special characters:: How to handle special characters
|
|
|
|
Publishing
|
|
|
|
* Configuration:: Defining projects
|
|
* Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
|
|
* Sample configuration:: Example projects
|
|
* Triggering publication:: Publication commands
|
|
|
|
Configuration
|
|
|
|
* Project alist:: The central configuration variable
|
|
* Sources and destinations:: From here to there
|
|
* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
|
|
* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
|
|
* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
|
|
* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
|
|
* Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
|
|
* Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
|
|
|
|
Sample configuration
|
|
|
|
* Simple example:: One-component publishing
|
|
* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
|
|
|
|
Working with source code
|
|
|
|
* Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
|
|
* Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
|
|
* Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
|
|
* Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
|
|
* Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
|
|
* Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
|
|
* Languages:: List of supported code block languages
|
|
* Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
|
|
* Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
|
|
* Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
|
|
* Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
|
|
* Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
|
|
|
|
Header arguments
|
|
|
|
* Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
|
|
* Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
|
|
|
|
Using header arguments
|
|
|
|
* System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
|
|
* Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
|
|
* Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
|
|
* Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
|
|
* Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
|
|
|
|
Specific header arguments
|
|
|
|
* var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
|
|
* results:: Specify the type of results and how they will be collected and handled
|
|
* file:: Specify a path for file output
|
|
* dir:: Specify the default directory for code block execution
|
|
* exports:: Export code and/or results
|
|
* tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
|
|
* no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb expansion during tangling
|
|
* session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
|
|
* noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
|
|
* cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
|
|
* hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
|
|
* colnames:: Handle column names in tables
|
|
* rownames:: Handle row names in tables
|
|
* shebang:: Make tangled files executable
|
|
|
|
Miscellaneous
|
|
|
|
* Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
|
|
* Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
|
|
* Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
|
|
* Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
|
|
* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
|
|
* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
|
|
* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
|
|
* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
|
|
* Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
|
|
|
|
Interaction with other packages
|
|
|
|
* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
|
|
* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
|
|
|
|
Hacking
|
|
|
|
* Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
|
|
* Add-on packages:: Available extensions
|
|
* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
|
|
* Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
|
|
* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
|
|
* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
|
|
* Special agenda views:: Customized views
|
|
* Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
|
|
* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
|
|
* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
|
|
|
|
Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
|
|
|
|
* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
|
|
* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
|
|
* Translator functions:: Copy and modify
|
|
* Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
|
|
|
|
MobileOrg
|
|
|
|
* Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
|
|
* Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
|
|
* Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
|
|
|
|
@end detailmenu
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
|
|
@chapter Introduction
|
|
@cindex introduction
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
|
|
* Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
|
|
* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
|
|
* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
|
|
* Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
|
|
@section Summary
|
|
@cindex summary
|
|
|
|
Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
|
|
project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
|
|
|
|
Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
|
|
lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
|
|
implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
|
|
content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
|
|
structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
|
|
with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
|
|
timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
|
|
agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
|
|
and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
|
|
Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
|
|
For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
|
|
structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
|
|
iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
|
|
linked web pages.
|
|
|
|
As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
|
|
nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
|
|
create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
|
|
|
|
Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows to work with
|
|
embedded source code block in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
|
|
documentation, and tangling.
|
|
|
|
Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
|
|
capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
|
|
minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
|
|
tables in arbitrary file types, for example in La@TeX{}. The structure
|
|
editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
|
|
the minor Orgstruct mode.
|
|
|
|
Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
|
|
feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
|
|
imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
|
|
it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
|
|
ends, for example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
|
|
@r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
|
|
@r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
|
|
@r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
|
|
@pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
|
|
@r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
|
|
@r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and La@TeX{} export}
|
|
@r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
|
|
@r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
@cindex FAQ
|
|
There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
|
|
version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
|
|
questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
|
|
@uref{http://orgmode.org}.
|
|
|
|
@page
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
|
|
@section Installation
|
|
@cindex installation
|
|
@cindex XEmacs
|
|
|
|
@b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
|
|
distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
|
|
to @ref{Activation}.}
|
|
|
|
If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
|
|
or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
|
|
to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
|
|
top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
|
|
binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
|
|
directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
|
|
access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
|
|
the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
|
|
Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
(setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
|
|
step for this directory:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
(setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@sp 2
|
|
@cartouche
|
|
XEmacs users now need to install the file @file{noutline.el} from
|
|
the @file{xemacs} sub-directory of the Org distribution. Use the
|
|
command:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
make install-noutline
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end cartouche
|
|
@sp 2
|
|
|
|
@noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
make
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
|
|
all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
|
|
administrator)
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
make install
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
|
|
@file{install-info} program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
|
|
correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
|
|
systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory separately, and
|
|
@file{install-info} then only modifies the directory file. Check your system
|
|
documentation to find out which of the following commands you need:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
make install-info
|
|
make install-info-debian
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
|
|
Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
|
|
when Org-mode starts.
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(require 'org-install)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
|
|
@page
|
|
|
|
@node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
|
|
@section Activation
|
|
@cindex activation
|
|
@cindex autoload
|
|
@cindex global key bindings
|
|
@cindex key bindings, global
|
|
|
|
Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
|
|
define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
|
|
@command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb}---please choose suitable
|
|
keys yourself.
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
|
|
(add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
|
|
(global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
|
|
(global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
|
|
(global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
|
|
buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
|
|
active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
|
|
(XEmacs users must use the second option):
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
|
|
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@cindex Org-mode, turning on
|
|
With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
|
|
into Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
|
|
like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
|
|
@noindent which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what
|
|
the file's name is. See also the variable
|
|
@code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
|
|
|
|
Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
|
|
use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
|
|
(@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
|
|
in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(transient-mark-mode 1)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
@noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
|
|
active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
|
|
@kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
|
|
|
|
@node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
|
|
@section Feedback
|
|
@cindex feedback
|
|
@cindex bug reports
|
|
@cindex maintainer
|
|
@cindex author
|
|
|
|
If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
|
|
about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
|
|
If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
|
|
list after a moderator has approved it.
|
|
|
|
For bug reports, please provide as much information as possible, including
|
|
the version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
|
|
(@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
|
|
@file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
|
|
@example
|
|
@kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
|
|
that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
|
|
from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
|
|
|
|
If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
|
|
create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
|
|
about:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item What exactly did you do?
|
|
@item What did you expect to happen?
|
|
@item What happened instead?
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
@noindent Thank you for helping to improve this mode.
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
|
|
|
|
@cindex backtrace of an error
|
|
If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
|
|
understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
|
|
providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
|
|
This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
|
|
error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
|
|
contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
|
|
To do this, use
|
|
@example
|
|
C-u M-x org-reload RET
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent
|
|
or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
|
|
menu.
|
|
@item
|
|
Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
|
|
(XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
|
|
@item
|
|
Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
|
|
document the steps you take.
|
|
@item
|
|
When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
|
|
screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
|
|
attach it to your bug report.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
@node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
|
|
@section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
|
|
|
|
Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
|
|
names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item TODO
|
|
@itemx WAITING
|
|
TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
|
|
user-defined.
|
|
@item boss
|
|
@itemx ARCHIVE
|
|
User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
|
|
meaning are written with all capitals.
|
|
@item Release
|
|
@itemx PRIORITY
|
|
User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
|
|
special meaning are written with all capitals.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
|
|
@chapter Document structure
|
|
@cindex document structure
|
|
@cindex structure of document
|
|
|
|
Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
|
|
edit the structure of the document.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
|
|
* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
|
|
* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
|
|
* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
|
|
* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
|
|
* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
|
|
* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
|
|
* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
|
|
* Blocks:: Folding blocks
|
|
* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
|
|
* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
|
|
@section Outlines
|
|
@cindex outlines
|
|
@cindex Outline mode
|
|
|
|
Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
|
|
document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
|
|
for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
|
|
of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
|
|
document to show only the general document structure and the parts
|
|
currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
|
|
outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
|
|
command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
|
|
|
|
@node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
|
|
@section Headlines
|
|
@cindex headlines
|
|
@cindex outline tree
|
|
@vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
|
|
@vindex org-special-ctrl-k
|
|
@vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
|
|
|
|
Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
|
|
start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
|
|
@code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
|
|
@code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
|
|
@kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.}. For example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* Top level headline
|
|
** Second level
|
|
*** 3rd level
|
|
some text
|
|
*** 3rd level
|
|
more text
|
|
|
|
* Another top level headline
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
|
|
outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
|
|
starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
|
|
An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
|
|
will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
|
|
least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
|
|
the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
|
|
variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
|
|
|
|
@node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
|
|
@section Visibility cycling
|
|
@cindex cycling, visibility
|
|
@cindex visibility cycling
|
|
@cindex trees, visibility
|
|
@cindex show hidden text
|
|
@cindex hide text
|
|
|
|
Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
|
|
Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
|
|
@kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
|
|
|
|
@cindex subtree visibility states
|
|
@cindex subtree cycling
|
|
@cindex folded, subtree visibility state
|
|
@cindex children, subtree visibility state
|
|
@cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex @key{TAB}
|
|
@item @key{TAB}
|
|
@emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
|
|
'-----------------------------------'
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
|
|
@vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
|
|
The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
|
|
the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
|
|
beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
|
|
@key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
|
|
option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
|
|
argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
|
|
|
|
@cindex global visibility states
|
|
@cindex global cycling
|
|
@cindex overview, global visibility state
|
|
@cindex contents, global visibility state
|
|
@cindex show all, global visibility state
|
|
@kindex S-@key{TAB}
|
|
@item S-@key{TAB}
|
|
@itemx C-u @key{TAB}
|
|
@emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
|
|
'--------------------------------------'
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
|
|
CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
|
|
tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
|
|
|
|
@cindex show all, command
|
|
@kindex C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
|
|
@item C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
|
|
Show all, including drawers.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-r
|
|
@item C-c C-r
|
|
Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
|
|
and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
|
|
exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
|
|
(@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
|
|
level, all sibling headings. With double prefix arg, also show the entire
|
|
subtree of the parent.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-k
|
|
@item C-c C-k
|
|
Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x b
|
|
@item C-c C-x b
|
|
Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
|
|
buffer
|
|
@ifinfo
|
|
(@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
|
|
@end ifinfo
|
|
@ifnotinfo
|
|
(see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
|
|
@end ifnotinfo
|
|
will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
|
|
tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
|
|
but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
|
|
prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
|
|
negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
|
|
the previously used indirect buffer.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-startup-folded
|
|
@cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
|
|
When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
|
|
OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
|
|
configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
|
|
per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
|
|
buffer:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+STARTUP: overview
|
|
#+STARTUP: content
|
|
#+STARTUP: showall
|
|
#+STARTUP: showeverything
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@cindex property, VISIBILITY
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
|
|
and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
|
|
for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
|
|
@code{all}.
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-u C-u @key{TAB}
|
|
@item C-u C-u @key{TAB}
|
|
Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
|
|
requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
|
|
entries.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
|
|
@section Motion
|
|
@cindex motion, between headlines
|
|
@cindex jumping, to headlines
|
|
@cindex headline navigation
|
|
The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-n
|
|
@item C-c C-n
|
|
Next heading.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-p
|
|
@item C-c C-p
|
|
Previous heading.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-f
|
|
@item C-c C-f
|
|
Next heading same level.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-b
|
|
@item C-c C-b
|
|
Previous heading same level.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-u
|
|
@item C-c C-u
|
|
Backward to higher level heading.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-j
|
|
@item C-c C-j
|
|
Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
|
|
visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
|
|
you can use the following keys to find your destination:
|
|
@vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
|
|
@example
|
|
@key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
|
|
@key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
|
|
@key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
|
|
@kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
|
|
@r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
|
|
n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
|
|
f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
|
|
u @r{One level up.}
|
|
0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
|
|
q @r{Quit}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@vindex org-goto-interface
|
|
@noindent
|
|
See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
|
|
@section Structure editing
|
|
@cindex structure editing
|
|
@cindex headline, promotion and demotion
|
|
@cindex promotion, of subtrees
|
|
@cindex demotion, of subtrees
|
|
@cindex subtree, cut and paste
|
|
@cindex pasting, of subtrees
|
|
@cindex cutting, of subtrees
|
|
@cindex copying, of subtrees
|
|
@cindex sorting, of subtrees
|
|
@cindex subtrees, cut and paste
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex M-@key{RET}
|
|
@item M-@key{RET}
|
|
@vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
|
|
Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
|
|
plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
|
|
creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
|
|
to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
|
|
the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
|
|
the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
|
|
customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
|
|
command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
|
|
created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
|
|
the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
|
|
used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
|
|
of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
|
|
after the end of the subtree.
|
|
@kindex C-@key{RET}
|
|
@item C-@key{RET}
|
|
Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
|
|
current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
|
|
it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{RET}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{RET}
|
|
@vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
|
|
Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
|
|
variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
|
|
@kindex C-S-@key{RET}
|
|
@item C-S-@key{RET}
|
|
Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
|
|
@kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
|
|
subtree.
|
|
@kindex @key{TAB}
|
|
@item @key{TAB} @r{in new, empty entry}
|
|
In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
|
|
become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
|
|
and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
|
|
to the initial level.
|
|
@kindex M-@key{left}
|
|
@item M-@key{left}
|
|
Promote current heading by one level.
|
|
@kindex M-@key{right}
|
|
@item M-@key{right}
|
|
Demote current heading by one level.
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{left}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{left}
|
|
Promote the current subtree by one level.
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{right}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{right}
|
|
Demote the current subtree by one level.
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{up}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{up}
|
|
Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
|
|
level).
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{down}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{down}
|
|
Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-w
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-w
|
|
Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
|
|
With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x M-w
|
|
@item C-c C-x M-w
|
|
Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
|
|
sequential subtrees.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-y
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-y
|
|
Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
|
|
make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
|
|
also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
|
|
headline marker like @samp{****}.
|
|
@kindex C-y
|
|
@item C-y
|
|
@vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
|
|
@vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
|
|
Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
|
|
@code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
|
|
paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
|
|
C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
|
|
but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
|
|
previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
|
|
@code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
|
|
force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
|
|
yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
|
|
folding.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x c
|
|
@item C-c C-x c
|
|
Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
|
|
prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
|
|
timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
|
|
to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
|
|
more details, see the docstring of the command
|
|
@code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-w
|
|
@item C-c C-w
|
|
Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
|
|
@kindex C-c ^
|
|
@item C-c ^
|
|
Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
|
|
region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
|
|
sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
|
|
alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
|
|
creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
|
|
(in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
|
|
of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
|
|
your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
|
|
sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
|
|
entries will also be removed.
|
|
@kindex C-x n s
|
|
@item C-x n s
|
|
Narrow buffer to current subtree.
|
|
@kindex C-x n w
|
|
@item C-x n w
|
|
Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
|
|
@kindex C-c *
|
|
@item C-c *
|
|
Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
|
|
subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
|
|
removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
|
|
region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
|
|
only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
|
|
headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@cindex region, active
|
|
@cindex active region
|
|
@cindex transient mark mode
|
|
When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
|
|
demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
|
|
headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
|
|
line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
|
|
just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
|
|
inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
|
|
functionality.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
|
|
@section Sparse trees
|
|
@cindex sparse trees
|
|
@cindex trees, sparse
|
|
@cindex folding, sparse trees
|
|
@cindex occur, command
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
|
|
@vindex org-show-following-heading
|
|
@vindex org-show-siblings
|
|
@vindex org-show-entry-below
|
|
An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
|
|
trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
|
|
document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
|
|
visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
|
|
variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
|
|
@code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
|
|
control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
|
|
and you will see immediately how it works.
|
|
|
|
Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
|
|
commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c /
|
|
@item C-c /
|
|
This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
|
|
@kindex C-c / r
|
|
@item C-c / r
|
|
@vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
|
|
Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
|
|
the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
|
|
the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
|
|
provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
|
|
is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
|
|
highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
|
|
editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
|
|
@code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
|
|
When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
|
|
so several calls to this command can be stacked.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
|
|
use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
|
|
keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
|
|
accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
|
|
For example:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
'(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
|
|
a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
|
|
|
|
The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
|
|
tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v
|
|
@cindex printing sparse trees
|
|
@cindex visible text, printing
|
|
To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
|
|
@code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
|
|
of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
|
|
XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
|
|
Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
|
|
part of the document and print the resulting file.
|
|
|
|
@node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
|
|
@section Plain lists
|
|
@cindex plain lists
|
|
@cindex lists, plain
|
|
@cindex lists, ordered
|
|
@cindex ordered lists
|
|
|
|
Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
|
|
additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of
|
|
checkboxes (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists,
|
|
and the HTML exporter (@pxref{Exporting}) parses and formats them.
|
|
|
|
Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
@emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
|
|
@samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
|
|
they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
|
|
stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
|
|
visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
|
|
@samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
|
|
as bullets.
|
|
@item
|
|
@emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
|
|
a right parenthesis, such as @samp{1.} or @samp{1)}. If you want a list to
|
|
start a different value (e.g. 20), start the text of the item with
|
|
@code{[@@start:20]}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
|
|
separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
|
|
description.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
|
|
Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
|
|
line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
|
|
2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
|
|
list. Indentation also determines the end of a list item. It ends before
|
|
the next line that is indented like the bullet/number, or less. Empty lines
|
|
are part of the previous item, so you can have several paragraphs in one
|
|
item. If you would like an empty line to terminate all currently open plain
|
|
lists, configure the variable @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.
|
|
Here is an example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@group
|
|
** Lord of the Rings
|
|
My favorite scenes are (in this order)
|
|
1. The attack of the Rohirrim
|
|
2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
|
|
+ this was already my favorite scene in the book
|
|
+ I really like Miranda Otto.
|
|
3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
|
|
- on DVD only
|
|
He makes a really funny face when it happens.
|
|
But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
|
|
Important actors in this film are:
|
|
- @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
|
|
- @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
|
|
him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
|
|
them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
|
|
XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
|
|
put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
|
|
properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
|
|
structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
|
|
blocks can be indented to signal that they should be part of a list item.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
|
|
If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
|
|
the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
|
|
@code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}.
|
|
|
|
The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line
|
|
of an item (the line with the bullet or number).
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex @key{TAB}
|
|
@item @key{TAB}
|
|
@vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
|
|
Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
|
|
the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
|
|
@code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. to @code{integrate}, plain list items
|
|
will be treated like low-level. The level of an item is then given by the
|
|
indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
|
|
headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
|
|
|
|
If @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists} has not been set, @key{TAB}
|
|
fixes the indentation of the current line in a heuristic way.
|
|
@kindex M-@key{RET}
|
|
@item M-@key{RET}
|
|
@vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
|
|
Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
|
|
heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
|
|
of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
|
|
item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
|
|
@code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed in the
|
|
@emph{whitespace before a bullet or number}, the new item is created
|
|
@emph{before} the current item. If the command is executed in the white
|
|
space before the text that is part of an item but does not contain the
|
|
bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{RET}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{RET}
|
|
Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
|
|
@kindex @key{TAB}
|
|
@item @key{TAB} @r{in new, empty item}
|
|
In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
|
|
become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
|
|
and so on, all the way to the left margin. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you
|
|
are back to the initial level.
|
|
@kindex S-@key{up}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{down}
|
|
@item S-@key{up}
|
|
@itemx S-@key{down}
|
|
@cindex shift-selection-mode
|
|
@vindex org-support-shift-select
|
|
Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
|
|
@code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
|
|
jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
|
|
similar effect.
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{up}
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{down}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{up}
|
|
@itemx M-S-@key{down}
|
|
Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
|
|
of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
|
|
automatic.
|
|
@kindex M-@key{left}
|
|
@kindex M-@key{right}
|
|
@item M-@key{left}
|
|
@itemx M-@key{right}
|
|
Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{left}
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{right}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{left}
|
|
@itemx M-S-@key{right}
|
|
Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
|
|
Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation.
|
|
When these commands are executed several times in direct succession,
|
|
the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation
|
|
would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break
|
|
the command chain with a cursor motion or so.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
|
|
state of the checkbox. If not, this command makes sure that all the
|
|
items on this list level use the same bullet. Furthermore, if this is
|
|
an ordered list, make sure the numbering is OK.
|
|
@kindex C-c -
|
|
@item C-c -
|
|
Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
|
|
(@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}). With a numeric prefix
|
|
argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an active
|
|
region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
|
|
first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed from the
|
|
list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
|
|
converted into a list item.
|
|
@kindex C-c *
|
|
@item C-c *
|
|
Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
|
|
its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
|
|
@kindex S-@key{left}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{right}
|
|
@item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
|
|
@vindex org-support-shift-select
|
|
This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
|
|
anywhere in an item line, details depending on
|
|
@code{org-support-shift-select}.
|
|
@kindex C-c ^
|
|
@item C-c ^
|
|
Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
|
|
numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
|
|
@section Drawers
|
|
@cindex drawers
|
|
@cindex #+DRAWERS
|
|
@cindex visibility cycling, drawers
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-drawers
|
|
Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
|
|
normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has @emph{drawers}.
|
|
Drawers need to be configured with the variable
|
|
@code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
|
|
with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
|
|
look like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
** This is a headline
|
|
Still outside the drawer
|
|
:DRAWERNAME:
|
|
This is inside the drawer.
|
|
:END:
|
|
After the drawer.
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
|
|
show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
|
|
look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
|
|
press @key{TAB} there. Org-mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
|
|
storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
|
|
for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
|
|
(@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
|
|
want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way as this is
|
|
done by state changes, use
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-z
|
|
@item C-c C-z
|
|
Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
|
|
@section Blocks
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-hide-block-startup
|
|
@cindex blocks, folding
|
|
Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
|
|
code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
|
|
information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
|
|
unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
|
|
folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
|
|
or on a per-file basis by using
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@example
|
|
#+STARTUP: hideblocks
|
|
#+STARTUP: nohideblocks
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
|
|
@section Footnotes
|
|
@cindex footnotes
|
|
|
|
Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
|
|
@file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
|
|
larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
|
|
syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
|
|
defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
|
|
brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
|
|
inside a footnote, use the La@TeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
|
|
is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
|
|
...
|
|
[fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
|
|
optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
|
|
@file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
|
|
encouraged because of possible conflicts with La@TeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
|
|
LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item [1]
|
|
A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
|
|
recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
|
|
snippet.
|
|
@item [fn:name]
|
|
A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
|
|
simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
|
|
@item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
|
|
A La@TeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
|
|
reference point.
|
|
@item [fn:name: a definition]
|
|
An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
|
|
Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
|
|
@code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-footnote-auto-label
|
|
Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
|
|
This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
|
|
corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords, see the docstring of that variable
|
|
for details.
|
|
|
|
@noindent The following command handles footnotes:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x f
|
|
@item C-c C-x f
|
|
The footnote action command.
|
|
|
|
When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
|
|
is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-footnote-define-inline
|
|
@vindex org-footnote-section
|
|
@vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
|
|
Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
|
|
@code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
|
|
setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
|
|
definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
|
|
separately into the location determined by the variable
|
|
@code{org-footnote-section}.
|
|
|
|
When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
|
|
options is offered:
|
|
@example
|
|
s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
|
|
@r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
|
|
@r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
|
|
@r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
|
|
@r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
|
|
@r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
|
|
r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
|
|
@r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
|
|
@r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
|
|
S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
|
|
n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
|
|
@r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
|
|
@r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
|
|
@r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
|
|
@r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
|
|
@r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
|
|
d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
|
|
@r{to it.}
|
|
@end example
|
|
Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
|
|
corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
|
|
renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
|
|
deletion.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
|
|
the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
|
|
location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-o
|
|
@kindex mouse-1
|
|
@kindex mouse-2
|
|
@item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
|
|
Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
|
|
you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
|
|
@section The Orgstruct minor mode
|
|
@cindex Orgstruct mode
|
|
@cindex minor mode for structure editing
|
|
|
|
If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list
|
|
formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
|
|
Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
|
|
this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
|
|
turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode, with one of:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
|
|
(add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
|
|
headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
|
|
will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
|
|
major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
|
|
lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadow. When you use
|
|
@code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
|
|
settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
|
|
item.
|
|
|
|
@node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
|
|
@chapter Tables
|
|
@cindex tables
|
|
@cindex editing tables
|
|
|
|
Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
|
|
calculations are supported in connection with the Emacs @file{calc}
|
|
package
|
|
@ifinfo
|
|
(@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
|
|
@end ifinfo
|
|
@ifnotinfo
|
|
(see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
|
|
calculator).
|
|
@end ifnotinfo
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
|
|
* Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
|
|
* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
|
|
* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
|
|
* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
|
|
* Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
|
|
@section The built-in table editor
|
|
@cindex table editor, built-in
|
|
|
|
Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
|
|
@samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
|
|
table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
|
|
this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
| Name | Phone | Age |
|
|
|-------+-------+-----|
|
|
| Peter | 1234 | 17 |
|
|
| Anna | 4321 | 25 |
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
|
|
@key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
|
|
the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
|
|
at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
|
|
of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
|
|
@samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
|
|
expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
|
|
create the above table, you would only type
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
|Name|Phone|Age|
|
|
|-
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
|
|
fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
|
|
@kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-enable-table-editor
|
|
@vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
|
|
When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
|
|
@key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
|
|
inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
|
|
typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
|
|
with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
|
|
field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
|
|
unpredictable for you, configure the variables
|
|
@code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
|
|
@kindex C-c |
|
|
@item C-c |
|
|
Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
|
|
TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
|
|
If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
|
|
If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
|
|
argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
|
|
C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
|
|
consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
|
|
@*
|
|
If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
|
|
table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
|
|
@kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
|
|
|
|
@tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex @key{TAB}
|
|
@item @key{TAB}
|
|
Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
|
|
necessary.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex S-@key{TAB}
|
|
@item S-@key{TAB}
|
|
Re-align, move to previous field.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex @key{RET}
|
|
@item @key{RET}
|
|
Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
|
|
necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
|
|
NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex M-a
|
|
@item M-a
|
|
Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
|
|
@kindex M-e
|
|
@item M-e
|
|
Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
|
|
|
|
@tsubheading{Column and row editing}
|
|
@kindex M-@key{left}
|
|
@kindex M-@key{right}
|
|
@item M-@key{left}
|
|
@itemx M-@key{right}
|
|
Move the current column left/right.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{left}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{left}
|
|
Kill the current column.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{right}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{right}
|
|
Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex M-@key{up}
|
|
@kindex M-@key{down}
|
|
@item M-@key{up}
|
|
@itemx M-@key{down}
|
|
Move the current row up/down.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{up}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{up}
|
|
Kill the current row or horizontal line.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{down}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{down}
|
|
Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
|
|
created below the current one.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c -
|
|
@item C-c -
|
|
Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
|
|
is created above the current line.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c @key{RET}
|
|
@item C-c @key{RET}
|
|
Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
|
|
below that line.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c ^
|
|
@item C-c ^
|
|
Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
|
|
column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
|
|
between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
|
|
point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
|
|
column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
|
|
and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
|
|
included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
|
|
(alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
|
|
argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
|
|
|
|
@tsubheading{Regions}
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x M-w
|
|
@item C-c C-x M-w
|
|
Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
|
|
mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
|
|
copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-w
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-w
|
|
Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
|
|
blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-y
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-y
|
|
Paste a rectangular region into a table.
|
|
The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
|
|
will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
|
|
the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
|
|
lines.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex M-@key{RET}
|
|
@itemx M-@kbd{RET}
|
|
Wrap several fields in a column like a paragraph. If there is an active
|
|
region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the
|
|
column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric
|
|
prefix argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there
|
|
is no region, the current field is split at the cursor position and the text
|
|
fragment to the right of the cursor is prepended to the field one line
|
|
down. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current
|
|
field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field above.
|
|
|
|
@tsubheading{Calculations}
|
|
@cindex formula, in tables
|
|
@cindex calculations, in tables
|
|
@cindex region, active
|
|
@cindex active region
|
|
@cindex transient mark mode
|
|
@kindex C-c +
|
|
@item C-c +
|
|
Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
|
|
the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
|
|
be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex S-@key{RET}
|
|
@item S-@key{RET}
|
|
@vindex org-table-copy-increment
|
|
When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
|
|
empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
|
|
Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
|
|
values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
|
|
be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
|
|
increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
|
|
(@pxref{Conflicts}).
|
|
|
|
@tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
|
|
@kindex C-c `
|
|
@item C-c `
|
|
Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
|
|
are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
|
|
a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
|
|
edited in place.
|
|
@c
|
|
@item M-x org-table-import
|
|
Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
|
|
separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
|
|
from a database, because these programs generally can write
|
|
TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
|
|
the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
|
|
argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
|
|
separator.
|
|
@item C-c |
|
|
Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
|
|
buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
|
|
@kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
|
|
@c
|
|
@item M-x org-table-export
|
|
@vindex org-table-export-default-format
|
|
Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
|
|
exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
|
|
used to export the file can be configured in the variable
|
|
@code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
|
|
@code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
|
|
name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
|
|
general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
|
|
format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
|
|
detailed description.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
|
|
way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
|
|
it off with
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent Then the only table command that still works is
|
|
@kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
|
|
|
|
@node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
|
|
@section Column width and alignment
|
|
@cindex narrow columns in tables
|
|
@cindex alignment in tables
|
|
|
|
The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
|
|
also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
|
|
of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
|
|
|
|
Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
|
|
inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
|
|
columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
|
|
feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
|
|
in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
|
|
integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
|
|
will then set the width of this column to this value.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@group
|
|
|---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
|
|
| | | | | <6> |
|
|
| 1 | one | | 1 | one |
|
|
| 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
|
|
| 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
|
|
| 4 | four | | 4 | four |
|
|
|---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
|
|
Note that the full text is still in the buffer, it is only invisible.
|
|
To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
|
|
will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
|
|
@kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
|
|
open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
|
|
C-c}.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
|
|
When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
|
|
necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
|
|
be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
|
|
@code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
|
|
upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
|
|
on a per-file basis with:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+STARTUP: align
|
|
#+STARTUP: noalign
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
|
|
to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you and use @samp{<r>} or
|
|
@samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may also combine alignment and field
|
|
width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
|
|
|
|
Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
|
|
automatically when exporting the document.
|
|
|
|
@node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
|
|
@section Column groups
|
|
@cindex grouping columns in tables
|
|
|
|
When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
|
|
lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
|
|
however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
|
|
of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
|
|
order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
|
|
first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
|
|
contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
|
|
@samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
|
|
a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
|
|
marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
| N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
|
|
|---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
|
|
| / | < | | > | < | > |
|
|
| 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
|
|
| 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
|
|
| 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
|
|
|---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
|
|
#+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
|
|
every vertical line you would like to have:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
| N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
|
|
|----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
|
|
| / | < | | | < | |
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
|
|
@section The Orgtbl minor mode
|
|
@cindex Orgtbl mode
|
|
@cindex minor mode for tables
|
|
|
|
If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
|
|
might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
|
|
The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
|
|
the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
|
|
example in mail mode, use
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
|
|
in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
|
|
construct La@TeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
|
|
Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
|
|
@ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
|
|
|
|
@node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
|
|
@section The spreadsheet
|
|
@cindex calculations, in tables
|
|
@cindex spreadsheet capabilities
|
|
@cindex @file{calc} package
|
|
|
|
The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
|
|
spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
|
|
derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
|
|
is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
|
|
of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
|
|
column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
|
|
also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
|
|
fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
|
|
formula, moving these references by arrow keys
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* References:: How to refer to another field or range
|
|
* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
|
|
* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
|
|
* Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
|
|
* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
|
|
* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
|
|
* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
|
|
* Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
|
|
@subsection References
|
|
@cindex references
|
|
|
|
To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
|
|
reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
|
|
by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
|
|
out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
|
|
field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Field references
|
|
@cindex field references
|
|
@cindex references, to fields
|
|
|
|
Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
|
|
any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
|
|
combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
|
|
@c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
|
|
@c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
|
|
@c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
|
|
@example
|
|
@@@var{row}$@var{column}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{@var{N}},
|
|
or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
|
|
|
|
The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
|
|
separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
|
|
@samp{1}...@samp{@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
|
|
@samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
|
|
hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
|
|
hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
|
|
starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
|
|
the second, etc@. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
|
|
current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
|
|
You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
|
|
third hline in the table.
|
|
|
|
@samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
|
|
either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
|
|
row/column is implied.
|
|
|
|
Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
|
|
in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
|
|
different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
|
|
Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
|
|
references because the same reference operator can reference different
|
|
fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
|
|
|
|
As a special case, references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used
|
|
to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
|
|
table.
|
|
|
|
Here are a few examples:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
|
|
C2 @r{same as previous}
|
|
$5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
|
|
E& @r{same as previous}
|
|
@@2 @r{current column, row 2}
|
|
@@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
|
|
@@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Range references
|
|
@cindex range references
|
|
@cindex references, to ranges
|
|
|
|
You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
|
|
references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
|
|
current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
|
|
is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
|
|
format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
|
|
@samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
$1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
|
|
$P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
|
|
@@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
|
|
A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
|
|
@@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
|
|
into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
|
|
suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
|
|
see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
|
|
@samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
|
|
@cindex field coordinates
|
|
@cindex coordinates, of field
|
|
@cindex row, of field coordinates
|
|
@cindex column, of field coordinates
|
|
|
|
For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
|
|
get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
|
|
The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
|
|
and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
|
|
$3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
|
|
@r{column 3 of the current table}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
|
|
as the current table. Inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
|
|
O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
|
|
number of rows.
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Named references
|
|
@cindex named references
|
|
@cindex references, named
|
|
@cindex name, of column or field
|
|
@cindex constants, in calculations
|
|
@cindex #+CONSTANTS
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-table-formula-constants
|
|
@samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
|
|
constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
|
|
@code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
|
|
line like
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex constants-unit-system
|
|
@pindex constants.el
|
|
Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
|
|
constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
|
|
@samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
|
|
outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
|
|
@file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
|
|
including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
|
|
units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
|
|
supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
|
|
and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
|
|
@code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
|
|
@code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
|
|
buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
|
|
lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
|
|
names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
|
|
numbers.
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Remote references
|
|
@cindex remote references
|
|
@cindex references, remote
|
|
@cindex references, to a different table
|
|
@cindex name, of column or field
|
|
@cindex constants, in calculations
|
|
@cindex #+TBLNAME
|
|
|
|
You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
|
|
either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
|
|
@code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
|
|
entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
|
|
table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
|
|
described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
|
|
referenced table.
|
|
|
|
@node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
|
|
@subsection Formula syntax for Calc
|
|
@cindex formula syntax, Calc
|
|
@cindex syntax, of formulas
|
|
|
|
A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
|
|
@file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
|
|
non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
|
|
@samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
|
|
evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
|
|
Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
|
|
Emacs Calc Manual}),
|
|
@c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
|
|
variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
|
|
@cindex vectors, in table calculations
|
|
The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
|
|
like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex format specifier
|
|
@cindex mode, for @file{calc}
|
|
@vindex org-calc-default-modes
|
|
A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
|
|
string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
|
|
execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
|
|
12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
|
|
format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
|
|
compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
|
|
@code{org-calc-default-modes}.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
|
|
n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
|
|
@r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
|
|
@r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
|
|
@r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
|
|
D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
|
|
F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
|
|
N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
|
|
T @r{force text interpretation}
|
|
E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
|
|
L @r{literal}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
|
|
and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
|
|
@code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
|
|
passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
|
|
formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
|
|
because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
|
|
@code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
|
|
signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
|
|
bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
|
|
A few examples:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
$1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
|
|
$1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
|
|
exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
|
|
$0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
|
|
($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
|
|
$c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
|
|
tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
|
|
sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
|
|
vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
|
|
vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
|
|
taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
|
|
@subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
|
|
@cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
|
|
|
|
It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful
|
|
for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's
|
|
functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote
|
|
followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form.
|
|
The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with
|
|
@file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a
|
|
semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way
|
|
field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a
|
|
reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes)
|
|
containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all
|
|
referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and
|
|
interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the
|
|
@samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes.
|
|
I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp
|
|
form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes, like
|
|
@code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
|
|
embed them in list or vector syntax. A few examples, note how the
|
|
@samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
|
|
'(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
|
|
@r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
|
|
'(+ $1 $2);N
|
|
@r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
|
|
'(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
|
|
@subsection Field formulas
|
|
@cindex field formula
|
|
@cindex formula, for individual table field
|
|
|
|
To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
|
|
field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
|
|
press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
|
|
the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
|
|
evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+TBLFM
|
|
Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
|
|
directly below the table. If you typed the equation in the 4th field of
|
|
the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
|
|
@samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
|
|
with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
|
|
ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
|
|
same field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure
|
|
with normal editing commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
|
|
The left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
|
|
features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
|
|
|
|
Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
|
|
following command
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c =
|
|
@item C-u C-c =
|
|
Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
|
|
formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
|
|
it to the current field, and stores it.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
|
|
@subsection Column formulas
|
|
@cindex column formula
|
|
@cindex formula, for table column
|
|
|
|
Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
|
|
particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
|
|
in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
|
|
column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
|
|
before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
|
|
and will not be modified by column formulas.
|
|
|
|
To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
|
|
column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
|
|
@key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
|
|
the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
|
|
and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
|
|
@samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
|
|
column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
|
|
@samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand
|
|
side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of column, it
|
|
must be the numeric column reference.
|
|
|
|
Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
|
|
following command:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c =
|
|
@item C-c =
|
|
Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
|
|
the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
|
|
taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
|
|
stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
|
|
will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
|
|
@subsection Editing and debugging formulas
|
|
@cindex formula editing
|
|
@cindex editing, of table formulas
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-table-use-standard-references
|
|
You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
|
|
field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
|
|
formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
|
|
converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
|
|
if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
|
|
@code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
|
|
@code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c =
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c =
|
|
@item C-c =
|
|
@itemx C-u C-c =
|
|
Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
|
|
minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field formulas}.
|
|
@kindex C-u C-u C-c =
|
|
@item C-u C-u C-c =
|
|
Re-insert the active formula (either a
|
|
field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
|
|
can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
|
|
minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
|
|
@kindex C-c ?
|
|
@item C-c ?
|
|
While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
|
|
referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
|
|
@kindex C-c @}
|
|
@item C-c @}
|
|
Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using
|
|
overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned; you can
|
|
force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
|
|
@kindex C-c @{
|
|
@item C-c @{
|
|
Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below.
|
|
@kindex C-c '
|
|
@item C-c '
|
|
Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
|
|
formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
|
|
active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
|
|
While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
|
|
any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
|
|
remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@kindex C-x C-s
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
@itemx C-x C-s
|
|
Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
|
|
prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-q
|
|
@item C-c C-q
|
|
Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-r
|
|
@item C-c C-r
|
|
Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
|
|
@code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
|
|
@kindex @key{TAB}
|
|
@item @key{TAB}
|
|
Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
|
|
a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
|
|
Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
|
|
formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
|
|
@kindex M-@key{TAB}
|
|
@item M-@key{TAB}
|
|
Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
|
|
@kindex S-@key{up}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{down}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{left}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{right}
|
|
@item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
|
|
Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
|
|
@code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
|
|
This also works for relative references and for hline references.
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{up}
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{down}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{up}/@key{down}
|
|
Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
|
|
down.
|
|
@kindex M-@key{up}
|
|
@kindex M-@key{down}
|
|
@item M-@key{up}/@key{down}
|
|
Scroll the window displaying the table.
|
|
@kindex C-c @}
|
|
@item C-c @}
|
|
Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
|
|
@end table
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
|
|
the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
|
|
line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
|
|
To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
|
|
prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
|
|
equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
|
|
recalculation commands in the table.
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Debugging formulas
|
|
@cindex formula debugging
|
|
@cindex debugging, of table formulas
|
|
When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
|
|
becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
|
|
on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
|
|
turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
|
|
calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
|
|
field. Detailed information will be displayed.
|
|
|
|
@node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
|
|
@subsection Updating the table
|
|
@cindex recomputing table fields
|
|
@cindex updating, table
|
|
|
|
Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
|
|
triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
|
|
recalculation at least semi-automatic.
|
|
|
|
In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
|
|
following commands:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c *
|
|
@item C-c *
|
|
Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
|
|
from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c *
|
|
@item C-u C-c *
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c C-c
|
|
@itemx C-u C-c C-c
|
|
Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
|
|
hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-u C-u C-c *
|
|
@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-u C-u C-c *
|
|
@itemx C-u C-u C-c C-c
|
|
Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
|
|
This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
|
|
fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
|
|
@item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
|
|
Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
|
|
@item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
|
|
Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
|
|
dependencies.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
|
|
@subsection Advanced features
|
|
|
|
If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
|
|
you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
|
|
to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-#
|
|
@item C-#
|
|
Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
|
|
@samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
|
|
change all marks in the region.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
|
|
makes use of these features:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@group
|
|
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
|
|
| | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
|
|
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
|
|
| ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
|
|
| # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
|
|
| ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
|
|
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
|
|
| # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
|
|
| # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
|
|
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
|
|
| | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
|
|
| ^ | | | | | at | |
|
|
| $ | max=50 | | | | | |
|
|
|---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
|
|
#+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
|
|
recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
|
|
are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
|
|
to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
|
|
empty first field.
|
|
|
|
@cindex marking characters, tables
|
|
The marking characters have the following meaning:
|
|
@table @samp
|
|
@item !
|
|
The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
|
|
refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
|
|
@item ^
|
|
This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
|
|
a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
|
|
the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
|
|
will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
|
|
@item _
|
|
Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
|
|
@emph{below}.
|
|
@item $
|
|
Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
|
|
example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
|
|
formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
|
|
Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
|
|
a per-table basis.
|
|
@item #
|
|
Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
|
|
@key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
|
|
is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
|
|
lines will be left alone by this command.
|
|
@item *
|
|
Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
|
|
not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
|
|
recalculation slows down editing too much.
|
|
@item
|
|
Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
|
|
All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
|
|
or @samp{*}.
|
|
@item /
|
|
Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
|
|
@samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
|
|
fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
|
|
series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
|
|
functions.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@group
|
|
|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
|
|
| | Func | n | x | Result |
|
|
|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
|
|
| # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
|
|
| # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
|
|
| # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
|
|
| # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
|
|
| # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
|
|
| * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
|
|
|---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
|
|
#+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
|
|
@section Org-Plot
|
|
@cindex graph, in tables
|
|
@cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
|
|
@cindex #+PLOT
|
|
|
|
Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
|
|
using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
|
|
@uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
|
|
this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
|
|
on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@group
|
|
#+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
|
|
| Sede | Max cites | H-index |
|
|
|-----------+-----------+---------|
|
|
| Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
|
|
| Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
|
|
| Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
|
|
| Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
|
|
| Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
|
|
Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
|
|
be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
|
|
for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
|
|
see the Org-plot tutorial at
|
|
@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Plot Options
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item set
|
|
Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
|
|
|
|
@item title
|
|
Specify the title of the plot.
|
|
|
|
@item ind
|
|
Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
|
|
|
|
@item deps
|
|
Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
|
|
and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
|
|
fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
|
|
column).
|
|
|
|
@item type
|
|
Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
|
|
|
|
@item with
|
|
Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
|
|
(e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
|
|
Defaults to @code{lines}.
|
|
|
|
@item file
|
|
If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
|
|
|
|
@item labels
|
|
List of labels to be used for the deps (defaults to the column headers if
|
|
they exist).
|
|
|
|
@item line
|
|
Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
|
|
|
|
@item map
|
|
When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
|
|
flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
|
|
|
|
@item timefmt
|
|
Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
|
|
Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
|
|
|
|
@item script
|
|
If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
|
|
between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
|
|
instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
|
|
the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
|
|
may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
|
|
the data file.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
|
|
@chapter Hyperlinks
|
|
@cindex hyperlinks
|
|
|
|
Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
|
|
other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
|
|
* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
|
|
* External links:: URL-like links to the world
|
|
* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
|
|
* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
|
|
* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
|
|
* Search options:: Linking to a specific location
|
|
* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
|
|
@section Link format
|
|
@cindex link format
|
|
@cindex format, of links
|
|
|
|
Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
|
|
clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
[[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
|
|
will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
|
|
of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
|
|
@samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
|
|
which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
|
|
visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
|
|
part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
|
|
edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
|
|
cursor on the link.
|
|
|
|
If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
|
|
displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
|
|
(invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
|
|
and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
|
|
missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
|
|
internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
|
|
@code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
|
|
|
|
@node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
|
|
@section Internal links
|
|
@cindex internal links
|
|
@cindex links, internal
|
|
@cindex targets, for links
|
|
|
|
@cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
|
|
If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
|
|
current file. The most important case is a link like
|
|
@samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
|
|
@code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
|
|
for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
|
|
links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
|
|
in a file.
|
|
|
|
Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
|
|
lead to a text search in the current file.
|
|
|
|
The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
|
|
or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
|
|
point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
|
|
a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
|
|
may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
|
|
comment line. For example
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
# <<My Target>>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
|
|
named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
|
|
text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
|
|
target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
|
|
first headline.}.
|
|
|
|
If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for the words in the link. In
|
|
the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}. Links starting
|
|
with a star like @samp{*My Target} restrict the search to
|
|
headlines@footnote{To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer
|
|
completion can be used. Just type a star followed by a few optional letters
|
|
into the buffer and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current
|
|
buffer will be offered as completions. @xref{Handling links}, for more
|
|
commands creating links.}. When searching, Org-mode will first try an
|
|
exact match, but then move on to more and more lenient searches. For
|
|
example, the link @samp{[[*My Targets]]} will find any of the following:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
** My targets
|
|
** TODO my targets are bright
|
|
** my 20 targets are
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
|
|
return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
|
|
several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
|
|
earlier.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
|
|
@subsection Radio targets
|
|
@cindex radio targets
|
|
@cindex targets, radio
|
|
@cindex links, radio targets
|
|
|
|
Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
|
|
in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
|
|
text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
|
|
enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
|
|
Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
|
|
become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
|
|
for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
|
|
update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
|
|
cursor on or at a target.
|
|
|
|
@node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
|
|
@section External links
|
|
@cindex links, external
|
|
@cindex external links
|
|
@cindex links, external
|
|
@cindex Gnus links
|
|
@cindex BBDB links
|
|
@cindex IRC links
|
|
@cindex URL links
|
|
@cindex file links
|
|
@cindex VM links
|
|
@cindex RMAIL links
|
|
@cindex WANDERLUST links
|
|
@cindex MH-E links
|
|
@cindex USENET links
|
|
@cindex SHELL links
|
|
@cindex Info links
|
|
@cindex Elisp links
|
|
|
|
Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
|
|
BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
|
|
logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
|
|
identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
|
|
the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
|
|
doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
|
|
file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
|
|
/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
|
|
file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
|
|
./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
|
|
file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
|
|
/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
|
|
file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
|
|
file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
|
|
file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
|
|
file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
|
|
docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open file in doc-view mode at page NNN}
|
|
id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
|
|
news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
|
|
mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
|
|
vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
|
|
vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
|
|
vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
|
|
wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
|
|
wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
|
|
mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
|
|
mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
|
|
rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
|
|
rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
|
|
gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
|
|
gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
|
|
bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
|
|
irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
|
|
info:org:External%20links @r{Info node link (with encoded space)}
|
|
shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
|
|
elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
|
|
elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
|
|
descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
|
|
format}), for example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
[[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
|
|
export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
|
|
button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
|
|
image,
|
|
that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
|
|
|
|
@cindex square brackets, around links
|
|
@cindex plain text external links
|
|
Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
|
|
as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
|
|
@samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
|
|
about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
|
|
|
|
@node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
|
|
@section Handling links
|
|
@cindex links, handling
|
|
|
|
Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
|
|
insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c l
|
|
@cindex storing links
|
|
@item C-c l
|
|
Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
|
|
must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
|
|
create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
|
|
buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
|
|
buffer:
|
|
|
|
@b{Org-mode buffers}@*
|
|
For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
|
|
to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
|
|
be the description.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
|
|
@cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
|
|
@cindex property, ID
|
|
If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
|
|
will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
|
|
@code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
|
|
created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
|
|
buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
|
|
ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
|
|
file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
|
|
to use.
|
|
|
|
@b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
|
|
Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
|
|
current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
|
|
constructed from the author and the subject.
|
|
|
|
@b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
|
|
Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
|
|
|
|
@b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
|
|
Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
|
|
|
|
@b{Chat: IRC}@*
|
|
@vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
|
|
For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
|
|
@code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
|
|
the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
|
|
the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
|
|
|
|
@b{Other files}@*
|
|
For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
|
|
(@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
|
|
there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
|
|
search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
|
|
accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
|
|
and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
|
|
The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
|
|
|
|
@b{Agenda view}@*
|
|
When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
|
|
entry referenced by the current line.
|
|
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-l
|
|
@cindex link completion
|
|
@cindex completion, of links
|
|
@cindex inserting links
|
|
@item C-c C-l
|
|
@vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
|
|
Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
|
|
insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
|
|
straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
|
|
enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
|
|
descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
|
|
You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
|
|
type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
|
|
into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
|
|
removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
|
|
a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
|
|
@code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
|
|
If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
|
|
becomes the default description.
|
|
|
|
@b{Inserting stored links}@*
|
|
All links stored during the
|
|
current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
|
|
them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
|
|
|
|
@b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
|
|
valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
|
|
defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
|
|
press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
|
|
specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
|
|
calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
|
|
example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
|
|
access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
|
|
@key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c C-l
|
|
@cindex file name completion
|
|
@cindex completion, of file names
|
|
@item C-u C-c C-l
|
|
When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
|
|
a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
|
|
the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
|
|
directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
|
|
directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
|
|
to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
|
|
is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
|
|
force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
|
|
@c
|
|
@item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
|
|
When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
|
|
link and description parts of the link.
|
|
@c
|
|
@cindex following links
|
|
@kindex C-c C-o
|
|
@kindex @key{RET}
|
|
@item C-c C-o @ @r{(or, if @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, also} @key{RET}
|
|
@vindex org-file-apps
|
|
Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
|
|
@command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
|
|
the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
|
|
cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
|
|
When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
|
|
TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
|
|
date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
|
|
with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
|
|
Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
|
|
@code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
|
|
visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
|
|
opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
|
|
If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
|
|
headline and entry text.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex mouse-2
|
|
@kindex mouse-1
|
|
@item mouse-2
|
|
@itemx mouse-1
|
|
On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
|
|
would. Under Emacs 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex mouse-3
|
|
@item mouse-3
|
|
@vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
|
|
Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
|
|
internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
|
|
variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
|
|
@c
|
|
@cindex inlining images
|
|
@cindex images, inlining
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-v
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-v
|
|
Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
|
|
images that have no description part in the link, i.e. images that will also
|
|
be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
|
|
images that do have a link description.
|
|
@cindex mark ring
|
|
@kindex C-c %
|
|
@item C-c %
|
|
Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
|
|
easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
|
|
@c
|
|
@cindex links, returning to
|
|
@kindex C-c &
|
|
@item C-c &
|
|
Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
|
|
commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
|
|
command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
|
|
previously recorded positions.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-n
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-p
|
|
@cindex links, finding next/previous
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-n
|
|
@itemx C-c C-x C-p
|
|
Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
|
|
the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
|
|
bindings for this are really too long, you might want to bind this also
|
|
to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(add-hook 'org-load-hook
|
|
(lambda ()
|
|
(define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
|
|
(define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
|
|
@section Using links outside Org
|
|
|
|
You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
|
|
Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
|
|
global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
|
|
yourself):
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
|
|
(global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
|
|
@section Link abbreviations
|
|
@cindex link abbreviations
|
|
@cindex abbreviation, links
|
|
|
|
Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
|
|
needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
|
|
abbreviated link looks like this
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
[[linkword:tag][description]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
|
|
where the tag is optional.
|
|
The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
|
|
letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
|
|
according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
|
|
that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
@group
|
|
(setq org-link-abbrev-alist
|
|
'(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
|
|
("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
|
|
("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/
|
|
nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
|
|
replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
|
|
in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
|
|
be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
|
|
|
|
With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
|
|
@code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
|
|
@code{[[google:OrgMode]]} and find out what the Org author is
|
|
doing besides Emacs hacking with @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
|
|
|
|
If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
|
|
can define them in the file with
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+LINK
|
|
@example
|
|
#+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
|
|
#+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
|
|
complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
|
|
@code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
|
|
support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
|
|
not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
|
|
|
|
@node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
|
|
@section Search options in file links
|
|
@cindex search option in file links
|
|
@cindex file links, searching
|
|
|
|
File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
|
|
particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
|
|
line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
|
|
compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
|
|
example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
|
|
links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
|
|
string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
|
|
link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
|
|
|
|
Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
|
|
link, together with an explanation:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
[[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
|
|
[[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
|
|
[[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
|
|
[[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
|
|
[[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item 255
|
|
Jump to line 255.
|
|
@item My Target
|
|
Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
|
|
@samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
|
|
@ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
|
|
link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
|
|
the linked file.
|
|
@item *My Target
|
|
In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
|
|
@item #my-custom-id
|
|
Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
|
|
@item /regexp/
|
|
Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
|
|
command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
|
|
target file is in Org-mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
|
|
sparse tree with the matches.
|
|
@c If the target file is a directory,
|
|
@c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
|
|
to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
|
|
a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
|
|
@samp{[[find me]]} would.
|
|
|
|
@node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
|
|
@section Custom Searches
|
|
@cindex custom search strings
|
|
@cindex search strings, custom
|
|
|
|
The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
|
|
actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
|
|
cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
|
|
@samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
|
|
because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
|
|
citation key.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-create-file-search-functions
|
|
@vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
|
|
If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
|
|
the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
|
|
for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
|
|
to be added to the hook variables
|
|
@code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
|
|
@code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
|
|
variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
|
|
for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
|
|
an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
|
|
|
|
@node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
|
|
@chapter TODO items
|
|
@cindex TODO items
|
|
|
|
Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
|
|
course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
|
|
but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
|
|
notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
|
|
mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
|
|
information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
|
|
item emerged is always present.
|
|
|
|
Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
|
|
throughout your notes file. Org-mode compensates for this by providing
|
|
methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
|
|
* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
|
|
* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
|
|
* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
|
|
* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
|
|
* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
|
|
@section Basic TODO functionality
|
|
|
|
Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
|
|
@samp{TODO}, for example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
*** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-t
|
|
@cindex cycling, of TODO states
|
|
@item C-c C-t
|
|
Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
|
|
'--------------------------------'
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
|
|
agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c C-t
|
|
@item C-u C-c C-t
|
|
Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
|
|
the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
|
|
to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
|
|
more information.
|
|
|
|
@kindex S-@key{right}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{left}
|
|
@vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
|
|
@item S-@key{right}
|
|
@itemx S-@key{left}
|
|
Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
|
|
mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
|
|
extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
|
|
with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
|
|
@code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
|
|
@kindex C-c / t
|
|
@cindex sparse tree, for TODO
|
|
@itemx C-c / t
|
|
@vindex org-todo-keywords
|
|
View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
|
|
entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
|
|
headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
|
|
/ T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
|
|
you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
|
|
entries that match any one of these keywords. With numeric prefix argument
|
|
N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
|
|
@code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
|
|
both un-done and done.
|
|
@kindex C-c a t
|
|
@item C-c a t
|
|
Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
|
|
from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
|
|
buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
|
|
manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
|
|
@xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
|
|
@kindex S-M-@key{RET}
|
|
@item S-M-@key{RET}
|
|
Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
|
|
Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
|
|
option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
|
|
|
|
@node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
|
|
@section Extended use of TODO keywords
|
|
@cindex extended TODO keywords
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-todo-keywords
|
|
By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
|
|
DONE. Org-mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
|
|
with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
|
|
special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
|
|
files.
|
|
|
|
Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
|
|
TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
|
|
* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
|
|
* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
|
|
* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
|
|
* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
|
|
* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
|
|
* TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
|
|
@subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
|
|
@cindex TODO workflow
|
|
@cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
|
|
|
|
You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
|
|
in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
|
|
this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org-mode in a
|
|
buffer.}:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-todo-keywords
|
|
'((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
|
|
action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
|
|
you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
|
|
state.
|
|
@cindex completion, of TODO keywords
|
|
With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
|
|
to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
|
|
also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
|
|
example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
|
|
Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
|
|
define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
|
|
(@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
|
|
(@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
|
|
buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
|
|
@ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
|
|
|
|
@node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
|
|
@subsection TODO keywords as types
|
|
@cindex TODO types
|
|
@cindex names as TODO keywords
|
|
@cindex types as TODO keywords
|
|
|
|
The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
|
|
@emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
|
|
that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
|
|
people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
|
|
directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
|
|
be set up like this:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
|
|
different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
|
|
person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this style by adapting
|
|
the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
|
|
@kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
|
|
times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
|
|
select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
|
|
time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
|
|
to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
|
|
name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
|
|
by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
|
|
Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
|
|
from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
|
|
argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
|
|
|
|
@node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
|
|
@subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
|
|
@cindex TODO keyword sets
|
|
|
|
Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
|
|
parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
|
|
@code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
|
|
separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
|
|
DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
|
|
like this:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-todo-keywords
|
|
'((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
|
|
(sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
|
|
(sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep track
|
|
of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
|
|
@kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
|
|
@code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
|
|
(nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
|
|
select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
|
|
keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-S-@key{right}
|
|
@kindex C-S-@key{left}
|
|
@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
|
|
@item C-u C-u C-c C-t
|
|
@itemx C-S-@key{right}
|
|
@itemx C-S-@key{left}
|
|
These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
|
|
@kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
|
|
@code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
|
|
@code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
|
|
@code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
|
|
@kindex S-@key{right}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{left}
|
|
@item S-@key{right}
|
|
@itemx S-@key{left}
|
|
@kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
|
|
keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
|
|
from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
|
|
@ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
|
|
@code{shift-selection-mode}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
|
|
@subsection Fast access to TODO states
|
|
|
|
If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
|
|
instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
|
|
single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
|
|
key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-todo-keywords
|
|
'((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
|
|
(sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
|
|
(sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
|
|
If you then press @code{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
|
|
will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
|
|
keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
|
|
@code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
|
|
state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
|
|
mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
|
|
unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
|
|
|
|
@node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
|
|
@subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
|
|
@cindex keyword options
|
|
@cindex per-file keywords
|
|
@cindex #+TODO
|
|
@cindex #+TYP_TODO
|
|
@cindex #+SEQ_TODO
|
|
|
|
It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
|
|
different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
|
|
to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
|
|
only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
|
|
need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
|
|
file:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
|
|
interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TODO: TODO | DONE
|
|
#+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
|
|
#+TODO: | CANCELED
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@cindex completion, of option keywords
|
|
@kindex M-@key{TAB}
|
|
@noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
|
|
@samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
|
|
|
|
@cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
|
|
Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
|
|
if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
|
|
may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
|
|
@kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
|
|
known to Org-mode@footnote{Org-mode parses these lines only when
|
|
Org-mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
|
|
cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org-mode
|
|
for the current buffer.}.
|
|
|
|
@node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
|
|
@subsection Faces for TODO keywords
|
|
@cindex faces, for TODO keywords
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
|
|
@vindex org-done @r{(face)}
|
|
@vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
|
|
Org-mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
|
|
for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
|
|
@code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
|
|
you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
|
|
special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
|
|
@code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
@group
|
|
(setq org-todo-keyword-faces
|
|
'(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
|
|
("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
|
|
work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
|
|
special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
|
|
@code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
|
|
foreground or a background color.
|
|
|
|
@node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
|
|
@subsection TODO dependencies
|
|
@cindex TODO dependencies
|
|
@cindex dependencies, of TODO states
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
|
|
@cindex property, ORDERED
|
|
The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
|
|
dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
|
|
all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
|
|
there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
|
|
cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
|
|
the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
|
|
from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
|
|
Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
|
|
will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
|
|
example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* TODO Blocked until (two) is done
|
|
** DONE one
|
|
** TODO two
|
|
|
|
* Parent
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:ORDERED: t
|
|
:END:
|
|
** TODO a
|
|
** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
|
|
** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x o
|
|
@item C-c C-x o
|
|
@vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
|
|
@cindex property, ORDERED
|
|
Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
|
|
for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
|
|
inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
|
|
this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
|
|
@code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
|
|
@kindex C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
|
|
@item C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
|
|
Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
|
|
If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
|
|
that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
|
|
font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
|
|
|
|
@cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
|
|
@vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
|
|
You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
|
|
(@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
|
|
@code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
|
|
checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
|
|
|
|
If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
|
|
between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
|
|
module @file{org-depend.el}.
|
|
|
|
@page
|
|
@node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
|
|
@section Progress logging
|
|
@cindex progress logging
|
|
@cindex logging, of progress
|
|
|
|
Org-mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
|
|
you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
|
|
a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
|
|
per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
|
|
information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
|
|
work time}.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
|
|
* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
|
|
* Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
|
|
@subsection Closing items
|
|
|
|
The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
|
|
item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
|
|
in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}.
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-log-done 'time)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
|
|
of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
|
|
just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
|
|
through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
|
|
want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
|
|
corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-log-done 'note)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
|
|
the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
|
|
|
|
In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
|
|
(@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
|
|
display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
|
|
giving you an overview of what has been done.
|
|
|
|
@node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
|
|
@subsection Tracking TODO state changes
|
|
@cindex drawer, for state change recording
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
|
|
@vindex org-log-into-drawer
|
|
@cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
|
|
When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
|
|
might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
|
|
note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
|
|
time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
|
|
headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
|
|
@code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
|
|
want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
|
|
Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
|
|
behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
|
|
also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
|
|
@code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
|
|
|
|
Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org-mode
|
|
expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
|
|
adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
|
|
in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-todo-keywords
|
|
'((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex org-log-done
|
|
you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
|
|
request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
|
|
DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org-mode will record two timestamps
|
|
when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
|
|
However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
|
|
both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
|
|
the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
|
|
WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
|
|
@samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
|
|
entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
|
|
WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
|
|
logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
|
|
to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
|
|
when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
|
|
setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
|
|
configured.
|
|
|
|
You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
|
|
to a buffer:
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@cindex property, LOGGING
|
|
In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
|
|
single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
|
|
LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
|
|
on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
|
|
@code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
|
|
settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* TODO Log each state with only a time
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
|
|
:END:
|
|
* TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
|
|
:END:
|
|
* TODO No logging at all
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:LOGGING: nil
|
|
:END:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
|
|
@subsection Tracking your habits
|
|
@cindex habits
|
|
|
|
Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
|
|
called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
|
|
@code{org-modules}.
|
|
@item
|
|
The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
|
|
@item
|
|
The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
|
|
@item
|
|
The TODO has a scheduled date, with a @code{.+} style repeat interval.
|
|
@item
|
|
The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
|
|
syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
|
|
three days, but at most every two days.
|
|
@item
|
|
You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
|
|
for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it's not
|
|
enabled it's not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
|
|
meaningless.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
|
|
actual habit with some history:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
** TODO Shave
|
|
SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
|
|
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
|
|
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
|
|
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
|
|
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
|
|
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
|
|
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
|
|
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
|
|
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
|
|
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
|
|
- State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:STYLE: habit
|
|
:LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
|
|
:END:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
|
|
@code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
|
|
today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
|
|
after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
|
|
after four days have elapsed.
|
|
|
|
What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
|
|
consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
|
|
done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
|
|
past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item Blue
|
|
If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
|
|
@item Green
|
|
If the task could have been done on that day.
|
|
@item Yellow
|
|
If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
|
|
@item Red
|
|
If the task was overdue on that day.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
|
|
the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
|
|
the current day falls in the graph.
|
|
|
|
There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
|
|
habits are displayed in the agenda.
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item org-habit-graph-column
|
|
The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
|
|
overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea to keep your habits'
|
|
titles brief and to the point.
|
|
@item org-habit-preceding-days
|
|
The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
|
|
@item org-habit-following-days
|
|
The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
|
|
@item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
|
|
If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
|
|
default.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
|
|
temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
|
|
bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
|
|
which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
|
|
|
|
@node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
|
|
@section Priorities
|
|
@cindex priorities
|
|
|
|
If you use Org-mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
|
|
it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
|
|
placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
*** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex org-priority-faces
|
|
By default, Org-mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
|
|
@samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
|
|
treated as priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only in the
|
|
agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they have no
|
|
inherent meaning to Org-mode. The cookies can be highlighted with special
|
|
faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
|
|
|
|
Priorities can be attached to any outline tree entries; they do not need
|
|
to be TODO items.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c ,}
|
|
Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts for a
|
|
priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}. When you press
|
|
@key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the headline.
|
|
The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline and
|
|
agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex S-@key{up}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{down}
|
|
@item S-@key{up}
|
|
@itemx S-@key{down}
|
|
@vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
|
|
Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
|
|
@code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
|
|
also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
|
|
@ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
|
|
@code{shift-selection-mode}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-highest-priority
|
|
@vindex org-lowest-priority
|
|
@vindex org-default-priority
|
|
You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
|
|
@code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
|
|
@code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
|
|
these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
|
|
the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
|
|
priority):
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+PRIORITIES
|
|
@example
|
|
#+PRIORITIES: A C B
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
|
|
@section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
|
|
@cindex tasks, breaking down
|
|
@cindex statistics, for TODO items
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
|
|
It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
|
|
subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
|
|
with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
|
|
global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
|
|
the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
|
|
either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
|
|
be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
|
|
@kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* Organize Party [33%]
|
|
** TODO Call people [1/2]
|
|
*** TODO Peter
|
|
*** DONE Sarah
|
|
** TODO Buy food
|
|
** DONE Talk to neighbor
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
|
|
If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
|
|
the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
|
|
@code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
|
|
this issue.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
|
|
If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
|
|
subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
|
|
@code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
|
|
include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
|
|
property.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
|
|
:END:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
|
|
when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
(defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
|
|
"Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
|
|
(let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
|
|
(org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
|
|
|
|
(add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
|
|
large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
|
|
@section Checkboxes
|
|
@cindex checkboxes
|
|
|
|
Every item in a plain list (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a
|
|
checkbox by starting it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is
|
|
similar to TODO items (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight.
|
|
Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are often
|
|
great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use
|
|
them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or
|
|
use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's @file{org-mouse.el}).
|
|
|
|
Here is an example of a checkbox list.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* TODO Organize party [2/4]
|
|
- [-] call people [1/3]
|
|
- [ ] Peter
|
|
- [X] Sarah
|
|
- [ ] Sam
|
|
- [X] order food
|
|
- [ ] think about what music to play
|
|
- [X] talk to the neighbors
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
|
|
are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
|
|
parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
|
|
checked.
|
|
|
|
@cindex statistics, for checkboxes
|
|
@cindex checkbox statistics
|
|
@cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
|
|
@vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
|
|
The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
|
|
indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
|
|
and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
|
|
many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
|
|
be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
|
|
Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
|
|
headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
|
|
@code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
|
|
represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not just the direct
|
|
children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
|
|
@samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
|
|
result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
|
|
the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
|
|
@samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
|
|
count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
|
|
will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
|
|
to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
|
|
|
|
@cindex blocking, of checkboxes
|
|
@cindex checkbox blocking
|
|
@cindex property, ORDERED
|
|
If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
|
|
be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
|
|
off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
|
|
|
|
@noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
|
|
double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
|
|
intermediate state.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-b
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-b
|
|
Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
|
|
double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
|
|
intermediate state.
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item
|
|
If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
|
|
and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
|
|
arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
|
|
this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
|
|
@item
|
|
If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{RET}
|
|
@item M-S-@key{RET}
|
|
Insert a new item with a checkbox.
|
|
This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
|
|
(@pxref{Plain lists}).
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x o
|
|
@item C-c C-x o
|
|
@vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
|
|
@cindex property, ORDERED
|
|
Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
|
|
be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
|
|
this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
|
|
However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
|
|
for better visibility, customize the variable
|
|
@code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
|
|
@kindex C-c #
|
|
@item C-c #
|
|
Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
|
|
a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
|
|
updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
|
|
new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
|
|
changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
|
|
hand, use this command to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any
|
|
entry twice (checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c}).
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
|
|
@chapter Tags
|
|
@cindex tags
|
|
@cindex headline tagging
|
|
@cindex matching, tags
|
|
@cindex sparse tree, tag based
|
|
|
|
An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
|
|
information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org-mode has extensive
|
|
support for tags.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-tag-faces
|
|
Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
|
|
headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
|
|
@samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
|
|
@samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
|
|
Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
|
|
You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
|
|
@code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
|
|
(@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
|
|
* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
|
|
* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
|
|
@section Tag inheritance
|
|
@cindex tag inheritance
|
|
@cindex inheritance, of tags
|
|
@cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
|
|
|
|
@i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
|
|
heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
|
|
well. For example, in the list
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* Meeting with the French group :work:
|
|
** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
|
|
*** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
|
|
@samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
|
|
explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
|
|
a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
|
|
level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
|
|
with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
|
|
changes in the line.}:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+FILETAGS
|
|
@example
|
|
#+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
|
|
@vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
|
|
To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
|
|
the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
|
|
@code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
|
|
When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
|
|
on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
|
|
as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
|
|
complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
|
|
of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
|
|
match in a subtree, configure the variable
|
|
@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
|
|
|
|
@node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
|
|
@section Setting tags
|
|
@cindex setting tags
|
|
@cindex tags, setting
|
|
|
|
@kindex M-@key{TAB}
|
|
Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
|
|
After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
|
|
also a special command for inserting tags:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-q
|
|
@item C-c C-q
|
|
@cindex completion, of tags
|
|
@vindex org-tags-column
|
|
Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either offer
|
|
completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
|
|
below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
|
|
to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
|
|
tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
|
|
things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
|
|
demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-tag-alist
|
|
Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
|
|
default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
|
|
currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
|
|
of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
|
|
the default tags for a given file with lines like
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+TAGS
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
|
|
#+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
|
|
variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
|
|
in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TAGS:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
|
|
If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
|
|
in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
|
|
you may specify a list of tags with the variable
|
|
@code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
|
|
by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+STARTUP: noptag
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
By default Org-mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
|
|
entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
|
|
method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
|
|
deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
|
|
assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
|
|
globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
|
|
@file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
|
|
different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
|
|
like:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
|
|
can instead set the TAGS option line as:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
|
|
window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
|
|
@samp{\n} into the tag list
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent or write them in two lines:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
|
|
#+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
|
|
braces, as in:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
|
|
and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
|
|
|
|
@noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
|
|
these lines to activate any changes.
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
|
|
you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
|
|
of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
|
|
break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
|
|
configuration:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
|
|
("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
|
|
("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
|
|
(:endgroup . nil)
|
|
("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
|
|
automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
|
|
the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
|
|
corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
|
|
have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
|
|
keys:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@item a-z...
|
|
Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
|
|
tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
|
|
exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
|
|
@kindex @key{TAB}
|
|
@item @key{TAB}
|
|
Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
|
|
list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
|
|
@kindex @key{SPC}
|
|
@item @key{SPC}
|
|
Clear all tags for this line.
|
|
@kindex @key{RET}
|
|
@item @key{RET}
|
|
Accept the modified set.
|
|
@item C-g
|
|
Abort without installing changes.
|
|
@item q
|
|
If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
|
|
@item !
|
|
Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
|
|
exception) assign several tags from such a group.
|
|
@item C-c
|
|
Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
|
|
If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
|
|
selection window.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
|
|
the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
|
|
@samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
|
|
C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
|
|
@samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
|
|
alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
|
|
@samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
|
|
@key{RET} @key{RET}}.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
|
|
If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
|
|
modify your list of tags, set the variable
|
|
@code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
|
|
press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
|
|
after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
|
|
@kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
|
|
(in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
|
|
C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
|
|
window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
|
|
when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
|
|
|
|
@node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
|
|
@section Tag searches
|
|
@cindex tag searches
|
|
@cindex searching for tags
|
|
|
|
Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
|
|
information into special lists.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c \
|
|
@kindex C-c / m
|
|
@item C-c \
|
|
@itemx C-c / m
|
|
Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
|
|
@kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
|
|
@kindex C-c a m
|
|
@item C-c a m
|
|
Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
|
|
@xref{Matching tags and properties}.
|
|
@kindex C-c a M
|
|
@item C-c a M
|
|
@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
|
|
Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
|
|
only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
|
|
@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
|
|
like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
|
|
@samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
|
|
which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
|
|
string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
|
|
and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
|
|
@ref{Matching tags and properties}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
|
|
@chapter Properties and columns
|
|
@cindex properties
|
|
|
|
Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
|
|
are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties
|
|
are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
|
|
implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
|
|
an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
|
|
you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
|
|
using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
|
|
property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
|
|
values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
|
|
application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
|
|
where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
|
|
release, number of tracks, and so on.
|
|
|
|
Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
|
|
(@pxref{Column view}).
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
|
|
* Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
|
|
* Property searches:: Matching property values
|
|
* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
|
|
* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
|
|
* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
|
|
@section Property syntax
|
|
@cindex property syntax
|
|
@cindex drawer, for properties
|
|
|
|
Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
|
|
drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
|
|
is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
|
|
first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* CD collection
|
|
** Classic
|
|
*** Goldberg Variations
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:Title: Goldberg Variations
|
|
:Composer: J.S. Bach
|
|
:Artist: Glen Gould
|
|
:Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
|
|
:NDisks: 1
|
|
:END:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
|
|
by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
|
|
@emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
|
|
the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
|
|
corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
|
|
errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
|
|
publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* CD collection
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
|
|
:Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
|
|
:END:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
|
|
file, use a line like
|
|
@cindex property, _ALL
|
|
@cindex #+PROPERTY
|
|
@example
|
|
#+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-global-properties
|
|
Property values set with the global variable
|
|
@code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
|
|
Org files.
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The following commands help to work with properties:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex M-@key{TAB}
|
|
@item M-@key{TAB}
|
|
After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
|
|
in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x p
|
|
@item C-c C-x p
|
|
Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
|
|
necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
|
|
@item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
|
|
Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
|
|
inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
|
|
information like deadlines.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
|
|
@item C-c C-c s
|
|
Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
|
|
can be inserted using completion.
|
|
@kindex S-@key{right}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{left}
|
|
@item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
|
|
Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
|
|
@item C-c C-c d
|
|
Remove a property from the current entry.
|
|
@item C-c C-c D
|
|
Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
|
|
@item C-c C-c c
|
|
Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
|
|
nearest column format definition.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
|
|
@section Special properties
|
|
@cindex properties, special
|
|
|
|
Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org-mode
|
|
features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the
|
|
previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include
|
|
these states in a column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
|
|
queries. The following property names are special and should not be
|
|
used as keys in the properties drawer:
|
|
|
|
@cindex property, special, TODO
|
|
@cindex property, special, TAGS
|
|
@cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
|
|
@cindex property, special, CATEGORY
|
|
@cindex property, special, PRIORITY
|
|
@cindex property, special, DEADLINE
|
|
@cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
|
|
@cindex property, special, CLOSED
|
|
@cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
|
|
@cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
|
|
@cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
|
|
@cindex property, special, BLOCKED
|
|
@c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
|
|
@cindex property, special, ITEM
|
|
@example
|
|
TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
|
|
TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
|
|
ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
|
|
CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
|
|
PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
|
|
DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
|
|
SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
|
|
CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
|
|
TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
|
|
TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
|
|
CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
|
|
@r{must be run first to compute the values.}
|
|
BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
|
|
ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
|
|
@section Property searches
|
|
@cindex properties, searching
|
|
@cindex searching, of properties
|
|
|
|
To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
|
|
the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c \
|
|
@kindex C-c / m
|
|
@item C-c \
|
|
@itemx C-c / m
|
|
Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
|
|
@kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
|
|
@kindex C-c a m
|
|
@item C-c a m
|
|
Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
|
|
@xref{Matching tags and properties}.
|
|
@kindex C-c a M
|
|
@item C-c a M
|
|
@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
|
|
Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
|
|
only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
|
|
@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
|
|
properties}.
|
|
|
|
There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
|
|
single property:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c / p
|
|
@item C-c / p
|
|
Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
|
|
prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
|
|
is created with all entries that define this property with the given
|
|
value. If you enclose the value into curly braces, it is interpreted as
|
|
a regular expression and matched against the property values.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
|
|
@section Property Inheritance
|
|
@cindex properties, inheritance
|
|
@cindex inheritance, of properties
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-use-property-inheritance
|
|
The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself for an
|
|
inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
|
|
property, the children can inherit this property. Org-mode does not
|
|
turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
|
|
significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
|
|
useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
|
|
@code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
|
|
all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
|
|
that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
|
|
inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
|
|
interpreted as an explicit undefine of he property, so that inheritance
|
|
search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
|
|
|
|
Org-mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
|
|
least for the special applications for which they are used:
|
|
|
|
@cindex property, COLUMNS
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item COLUMNS
|
|
The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
|
|
(@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
|
|
where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
|
|
point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
|
|
subtree from where columns view is turned on.
|
|
@item CATEGORY
|
|
@cindex property, CATEGORY
|
|
For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
|
|
applies to the entire subtree.
|
|
@item ARCHIVE
|
|
@cindex property, ARCHIVE
|
|
For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
|
|
location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
|
|
@item LOGGING
|
|
@cindex property, LOGGING
|
|
The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
|
|
subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
|
|
@section Column view
|
|
|
|
A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
|
|
@emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
|
|
table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
|
|
entries. Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
|
|
over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
|
|
into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
|
|
tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
|
|
view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
|
|
is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
|
|
headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
|
|
tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
|
|
Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
|
|
queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
|
|
* Using column view:: How to create and use column view
|
|
* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
|
|
@subsection Defining columns
|
|
@cindex column view, for properties
|
|
@cindex properties, column view
|
|
|
|
Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
|
|
done by defining a column format line.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
|
|
* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
|
|
@subsubsection Scope of column definitions
|
|
|
|
To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+COLUMNS
|
|
@example
|
|
#+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
|
|
@code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
** Top node for columns view
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
|
|
:END:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
|
|
for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
|
|
column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
|
|
you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
|
|
sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
|
|
deeper part of the tree.
|
|
|
|
@node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
|
|
@subsubsection Column attributes
|
|
A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
|
|
definition looks like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
%[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
|
|
optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
|
|
@r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
|
|
@var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
|
|
@r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
|
|
@r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
|
|
@var{(title)} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
|
|
@r{name is used.}
|
|
@{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
|
|
@r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
|
|
@r{Supported summary types are:}
|
|
@{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
|
|
@{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
|
|
@{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
|
|
@{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
|
|
@{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
|
|
@{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
|
|
@{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
|
|
@{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
|
|
@{max@} @r{Largest number.}
|
|
@{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
|
|
@{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
|
|
@{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
|
|
@{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
|
|
@{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
|
|
@{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
|
|
@{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
|
|
@{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
|
|
include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
|
|
same summary information.
|
|
|
|
The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
|
|
combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
|
|
of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
|
|
5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much woark is required, or
|
|
1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
|
|
average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
|
|
|
|
When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
|
|
produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
|
|
statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
|
|
from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
|
|
estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
|
|
of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
|
|
extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
|
|
full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
|
|
|
|
Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
|
|
values.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
:COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
|
|
%10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
|
|
:Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
|
|
:Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
|
|
:Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
|
|
item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
|
|
column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
|
|
create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
|
|
@samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
|
|
field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
|
|
character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
|
|
to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
|
|
modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
|
|
be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
|
|
expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
|
|
an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
|
|
@samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
|
|
in the subtree.
|
|
|
|
@node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
|
|
@subsection Using column view
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-c
|
|
@vindex org-columns-default-format
|
|
Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
|
|
column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
|
|
definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
|
|
searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
|
|
defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
|
|
for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
|
|
property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
|
|
@code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
|
|
and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
|
|
@kindex r
|
|
@item r
|
|
Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
|
|
@kindex g
|
|
@item g
|
|
Same as @kbd{r}.
|
|
@kindex q
|
|
@item q
|
|
Exit column view.
|
|
@tsubheading{Editing values}
|
|
@item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
|
|
Move through the column view from field to field.
|
|
@kindex S-@key{left}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{right}
|
|
@item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
|
|
Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
|
|
have to have specified allowed values for a property.
|
|
@item 1..9,0
|
|
Directly select the nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
|
|
@kindex n
|
|
@kindex p
|
|
@itemx n / p
|
|
Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
|
|
@kindex e
|
|
@item e
|
|
Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
|
|
invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
|
|
property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
|
|
or fast selection interface will pop up.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
|
|
@kindex v
|
|
@item v
|
|
View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
|
|
the column is smaller than that of the value.
|
|
@kindex a
|
|
@item a
|
|
Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
|
|
in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
|
|
found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
|
|
current column view.
|
|
@tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
|
|
@kindex <
|
|
@kindex >
|
|
@item < / >
|
|
Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
|
|
@kindex S-M-@key{right}
|
|
@item S-M-@key{right}
|
|
Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
|
|
@kindex S-M-@key{left}
|
|
@item S-M-@key{left}
|
|
Delete the current column.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
|
|
@subsection Capturing column view
|
|
|
|
Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
|
|
exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
|
|
a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
|
|
of this block looks like this:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
|
|
@example
|
|
* The column view
|
|
#+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
|
|
|
|
#+END:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item :id
|
|
This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
|
|
often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
|
|
at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
|
|
capture, you can use 4 values:
|
|
@cindex property, ID
|
|
@example
|
|
local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
|
|
global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
|
|
"file:@var{path-to-file}"
|
|
@r{run column view at the top of this file}
|
|
"@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
|
|
@r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
|
|
@r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
|
|
@r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@item :hlines
|
|
When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
|
|
an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
|
|
@item :vlines
|
|
When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
|
|
@item :maxlevel
|
|
When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
|
|
@item :skip-empty-rows
|
|
When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
|
|
column view is @code{ITEM}.
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x i
|
|
@item C-c C-x i
|
|
Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
|
|
for the scope or ID of the view.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-u
|
|
@itemx C-c C-x C-u
|
|
Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
|
|
@code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
|
|
@item C-u C-c C-x C-u
|
|
Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
|
|
you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
|
|
instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
|
|
block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
|
|
actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
|
|
|
|
An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
|
|
provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
|
|
package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
|
|
distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
|
|
@uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
|
|
properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
|
|
process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
|
|
|
|
@node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
|
|
@section The Property API
|
|
@cindex properties, API
|
|
@cindex API, for properties
|
|
|
|
There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
|
|
be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
|
|
features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
|
|
property API}.
|
|
|
|
@node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
|
|
@chapter Dates and times
|
|
@cindex dates
|
|
@cindex times
|
|
@cindex timestamp
|
|
@cindex date stamp
|
|
|
|
To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
|
|
a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
|
|
information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org-mode. This may be a
|
|
little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
|
|
something was created or last changed. However, in Org-mode this term
|
|
is used in a much wider sense.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
|
|
* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
|
|
* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
|
|
* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
|
|
* Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
|
|
* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
|
|
* Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
|
|
@section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
|
|
@cindex timestamps
|
|
@cindex ranges, time
|
|
@cindex date stamps
|
|
@cindex deadlines
|
|
@cindex scheduling
|
|
|
|
A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
|
|
times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
|
|
@samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
|
|
12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time
|
|
format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
|
|
timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
|
|
Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
|
|
(@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
|
|
|
|
@table @var
|
|
@item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
|
|
@cindex timestamp
|
|
A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
|
|
like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
|
|
timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
|
|
plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
|
|
* Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@item Timestamp with repeater interval
|
|
@cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
|
|
A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
|
|
applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
|
|
interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
|
|
following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@item Diary-style sexp entries
|
|
For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the
|
|
special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
|
|
package. For example
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
|
|
<%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@item Time/Date range
|
|
@cindex timerange
|
|
@cindex date range
|
|
Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
|
|
will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
|
|
that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
** Meeting in Amsterdam
|
|
<2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@item Inactive timestamp
|
|
@cindex timestamp, inactive
|
|
@cindex inactive timestamp
|
|
Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
|
|
angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
|
|
@emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
|
|
@section Creating timestamps
|
|
@cindex creating timestamps
|
|
@cindex timestamps, creating
|
|
|
|
For Org-mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
|
|
format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
|
|
format.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c .
|
|
@item C-c .
|
|
Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
|
|
at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
|
|
timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
|
|
succession, a time range is inserted.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c !
|
|
@item C-c !
|
|
Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
|
|
an agenda entry.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c .
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c !
|
|
@item C-u C-c .
|
|
@itemx C-u C-c !
|
|
@vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
|
|
Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
|
|
contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
|
|
minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c <
|
|
@item C-c <
|
|
Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c >
|
|
@item C-c >
|
|
Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
|
|
timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
|
|
instead.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-o
|
|
@item C-c C-o
|
|
Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
|
|
point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex S-@key{left}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{right}
|
|
@item S-@key{left}
|
|
@itemx S-@key{right}
|
|
Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
|
|
shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex S-@key{up}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{down}
|
|
@item S-@key{up}
|
|
@itemx S-@key{down}
|
|
Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
|
|
year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
|
|
like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
|
|
shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
|
|
the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
|
|
timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
|
|
(@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
|
|
related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-y
|
|
@cindex evaluate time range
|
|
@item C-c C-y
|
|
Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
|
|
With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
|
|
the following column).
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
|
|
* Custom time format:: Making dates look different
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
|
|
@subsection The date/time prompt
|
|
@cindex date, reading in minibuffer
|
|
@cindex time, reading in minibuffer
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
|
|
When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
|
|
date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
|
|
format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
|
|
time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
|
|
can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
|
|
copied from an email message. Org-mode will find whatever information is in
|
|
there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
|
|
and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
|
|
modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
|
|
range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
|
|
information, Org-mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
|
|
date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
|
|
@i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
|
|
variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
|
|
the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
|
|
tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
|
|
time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
|
|
|
|
For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
|
|
various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org-mode are
|
|
in @b{bold}.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
|
|
2/5/3 --> 2003-02-05
|
|
14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
|
|
12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
|
|
2/5 --> @b{2007}-02-05
|
|
Fri --> nearest Friday (default date or later)
|
|
sep 15 --> @b{2006}-09-15
|
|
feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
|
|
sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
|
|
12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
|
|
22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
|
|
w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
|
|
2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
|
|
2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
|
|
@emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
|
|
letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
|
|
single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
|
|
double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
|
|
a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
|
|
the nth such day. E.g.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
+0 --> today
|
|
. --> today
|
|
+4d --> four days from today
|
|
+4 --> same as above
|
|
+2w --> two weeks from today
|
|
++5 --> five days from default date
|
|
+2tue --> second Tuesday from now.
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex parse-time-months
|
|
@vindex parse-time-weekdays
|
|
The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
|
|
you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
|
|
the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex calendar, for selecting date
|
|
@vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
|
|
Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
|
|
you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
|
|
@code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
|
|
prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
|
|
@key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
|
|
information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
|
|
from the minibuffer:
|
|
|
|
@kindex <
|
|
@kindex >
|
|
@kindex M-v
|
|
@kindex C-v
|
|
@kindex mouse-1
|
|
@kindex S-@key{right}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{left}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{down}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{up}
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{right}
|
|
@kindex M-S-@key{left}
|
|
@kindex @key{RET}
|
|
@example
|
|
@key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
|
|
mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
|
|
S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
|
|
S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
|
|
M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
|
|
> / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
|
|
M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-read-date-display-live
|
|
The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
|
|
will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
|
|
way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
|
|
on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
|
|
minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
|
|
@code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
|
|
|
|
@node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
|
|
@subsection Custom time format
|
|
@cindex custom date/time format
|
|
@cindex time format, custom
|
|
@cindex date format, custom
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-display-custom-times
|
|
@vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
|
|
Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
|
|
defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
|
|
representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
|
|
customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
|
|
@code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-t
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-t
|
|
Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
|
|
format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
|
|
@emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
|
|
following consequences:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
|
|
after.
|
|
@item
|
|
The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
|
|
each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
|
|
the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
|
|
just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
|
|
time will be changed by one minute.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
|
|
will not be overlayed, but remain in the buffer as they were.
|
|
@item
|
|
When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
|
|
disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
|
|
belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
|
|
using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
|
|
format is shorter, things do work as expected.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
|
|
@section Deadlines and scheduling
|
|
|
|
A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
|
|
|
|
@table @var
|
|
@item DEADLINE
|
|
@cindex DEADLINE keyword
|
|
|
|
Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
|
|
to be finished on that date.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-deadline-warning-days
|
|
On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
|
|
addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
|
|
approaching or missed deadline, starting
|
|
@code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
|
|
until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
*** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
|
|
The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
|
|
DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
|
|
deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
|
|
period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
|
|
|
|
@item SCHEDULED
|
|
@cindex SCHEDULED keyword
|
|
|
|
Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
|
|
date.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
|
|
The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
|
|
be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
|
|
this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
|
|
addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
|
|
in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE.
|
|
I.e. the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
*** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
|
|
SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org-mode should @i{not} be
|
|
understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
|
|
Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
|
|
mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
|
|
on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
|
|
Org users. In Org-mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
|
|
want to start working on an action item.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
|
|
entries. Org-mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
|
|
assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
|
|
the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
|
|
@c
|
|
@code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
|
|
@c
|
|
in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org-mode does not
|
|
know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
|
|
late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
|
|
sexp entry matches.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
|
|
* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
|
|
@subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
|
|
|
|
The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
|
|
an item:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-d
|
|
@item C-c C-d
|
|
Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
|
|
in the line directly following the headline. When called with a prefix arg,
|
|
an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the
|
|
variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
|
|
@code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
|
|
and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
|
|
deadline.
|
|
@c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-s
|
|
@item C-c C-s
|
|
Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
|
|
happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
|
|
will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
|
|
date from the entry. Depending on the variable
|
|
@code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
|
|
keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline}, and
|
|
@code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
|
|
scheduling time.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-k
|
|
@kindex k a
|
|
@kindex k s
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-k
|
|
Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
|
|
like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
|
|
date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
|
|
schedule the marked item.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c / d
|
|
@cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
|
|
@item C-c / d
|
|
@vindex org-deadline-warning-days
|
|
Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
|
|
which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
|
|
With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
|
|
prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
|
|
all deadlines due tomorrow.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c / b
|
|
@item C-c / b
|
|
Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c / a
|
|
@item C-c / a
|
|
Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
|
|
@subsection Repeated tasks
|
|
@cindex tasks, repeated
|
|
@cindex repeated tasks
|
|
|
|
Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org-mode helps to
|
|
organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
|
|
or plain timestamp. In the following example
|
|
@example
|
|
** TODO Pay the rent
|
|
DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent
|
|
the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
|
|
has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
|
|
from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
|
|
a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
|
|
@code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
|
|
Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
|
|
over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
|
|
once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
|
|
keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
|
|
with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
|
|
repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode deals with this in the following
|
|
way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
|
|
shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
|
|
immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
|
|
state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
|
|
the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
|
|
specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
|
|
sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
|
|
switch the date like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
** TODO Pay the rent
|
|
DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-log-repeat
|
|
A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
|
|
@code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
|
|
@code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
|
|
will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
|
|
a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
|
|
|
|
As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
|
|
visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
|
|
will be visible.
|
|
|
|
With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
|
|
month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
|
|
entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
|
|
task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
|
|
forgot to call you father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
|
|
him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
|
|
like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
|
|
@i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org-mode has
|
|
special repeaters markers with @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
** TODO Call Father
|
|
DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
|
|
Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
|
|
but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
|
|
the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
|
|
and marked it done on Saturday.
|
|
** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
|
|
DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
|
|
Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
|
|
today.
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
|
|
task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
|
|
|
|
An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
|
|
subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
|
|
created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Clocking work time, Resolving idle time, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
|
|
@section Clocking work time
|
|
|
|
Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
|
|
project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
|
|
When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
|
|
clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
|
|
also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
|
|
remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
|
|
between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
|
|
|
|
To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-clock-persist 'history)
|
|
(org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
|
|
clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
|
|
on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
|
|
will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
|
|
what to do with it.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-i
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-i
|
|
@vindex org-clock-into-drawer
|
|
Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
|
|
keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
|
|
this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
|
|
@code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
|
|
@code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
|
|
select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
|
|
C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
|
|
The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
|
|
with letter @kbd{d}.@*
|
|
@cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
|
|
@cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
|
|
@vindex org-clock-modeline-total
|
|
While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
|
|
line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
|
|
time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
|
|
estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
|
|
clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
|
|
hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
|
|
is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
|
|
reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
|
|
will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
|
|
the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
|
|
@code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
|
|
show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
|
|
@code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
|
|
@code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
|
|
@code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
|
|
mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-o
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-o
|
|
@vindex org-log-note-clock-out
|
|
Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
|
|
location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
|
|
the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
|
|
HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
|
|
possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
|
|
timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
|
|
@code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-e
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-e
|
|
Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-y
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-y @ @ @r{or}@ @ C-c C-c
|
|
Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
|
|
is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
|
|
them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-t
|
|
@item C-c C-t
|
|
Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
|
|
if it is running in this same item.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-x
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-x
|
|
Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
|
|
mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-j
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-j
|
|
Jump to the entry that contains the currently running clock. With a
|
|
@kbd{C-u} prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked
|
|
tasks.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-d
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-d
|
|
@vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
|
|
Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
|
|
puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
|
|
recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
|
|
can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
|
|
when you change the buffer (see variable
|
|
@code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-r
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-r
|
|
Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
|
|
report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
|
|
at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
|
|
argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
|
|
update it.
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
|
|
#+END: clocktable
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent
|
|
If such a block already exists at point, its content is replaced by the
|
|
new table. The @samp{BEGIN} line can specify options:
|
|
@example
|
|
:maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
|
|
:emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
|
|
:scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
|
|
nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
|
|
file @r{the full current buffer}
|
|
subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
|
|
tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
|
|
tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
|
|
agenda @r{all agenda files}
|
|
("file"..) @r{scan these files}
|
|
file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
|
|
agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
|
|
:block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
|
|
@r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
|
|
@r{these formats:}
|
|
2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
|
|
2007-12 @r{December 2007}
|
|
2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
|
|
2007 @r{the year 2007}
|
|
today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
|
|
thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
|
|
thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
|
|
thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
|
|
@r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
|
|
:tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
|
|
:tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
|
|
:step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
|
|
@r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
|
|
:stepskip0 @r{Don't show steps that have zero time}
|
|
:tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute}
|
|
:link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
|
|
:formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
|
|
@r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
|
|
@r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula.}
|
|
@r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
|
|
:timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
|
|
@r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
|
|
@end example
|
|
To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
|
|
day, you could write
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
|
|
#+END: clocktable
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent
|
|
and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
|
|
parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
|
|
only to fit it into the manual.}
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
|
|
:tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
|
|
#+END: clocktable
|
|
@end example
|
|
A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
|
|
#+END: clocktable
|
|
@end example
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-u
|
|
@itemx C-c C-x C-u
|
|
Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
|
|
@code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
|
|
@item C-u C-c C-x C-u
|
|
Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
|
|
you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
|
|
@kindex S-@key{left}
|
|
@kindex S-@key{right}
|
|
@item S-@key{left}
|
|
@itemx S-@key{right}
|
|
Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
|
|
needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
|
|
@code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
|
|
the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
|
|
worked on or closed during a day.
|
|
|
|
@node Resolving idle time, Effort estimates, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
|
|
@section Resolving idle time
|
|
@cindex resolve idle time
|
|
|
|
@cindex idle, resolve, dangling
|
|
If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
|
|
computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
|
|
time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
|
|
applying it to another one.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-clock-idle-time
|
|
By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
|
|
as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
|
|
being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
|
|
idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
|
|
X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
|
|
UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
|
|
treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
|
|
only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
|
|
question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
|
|
passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
|
|
choices to correct the discrepancy:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@item k
|
|
To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
|
|
will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
|
|
effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
|
|
@item K
|
|
If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
|
|
you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
|
|
the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
|
|
@item s
|
|
To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
|
|
the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
|
|
@item S
|
|
To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
|
|
use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
|
|
leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
|
|
@item C
|
|
To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
|
|
canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
|
|
than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
|
|
log with an empty entry.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
|
|
want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
|
|
after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
|
|
the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
|
|
the next task you clock in on.
|
|
|
|
There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
|
|
were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
|
|
scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
|
|
lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
|
|
mode changes, including your last clock in.
|
|
|
|
If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
|
|
dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
|
|
that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
|
|
Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
|
|
identical to dealing with away time due to idleness, it's just happening due
|
|
to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
|
|
|
|
You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
|
|
clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
|
|
|
|
@node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Resolving idle time, Dates and Times
|
|
@section Effort estimates
|
|
@cindex effort estimates
|
|
|
|
@cindex property, Effort
|
|
@vindex org-effort-property
|
|
If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
|
|
produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
|
|
assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
|
|
may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
|
|
great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
|
|
special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
|
|
used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
|
|
for an entry with the following commands:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x e
|
|
@item C-c C-x e
|
|
Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
|
|
argument, set it to the NTH allowed value (see below). This command is also
|
|
accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-e
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-e
|
|
Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
|
|
(@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
|
|
effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
|
|
together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
|
|
buffer you can use
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
|
|
#+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex org-global-properties
|
|
@vindex org-columns-default-format
|
|
or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
|
|
variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
|
|
In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
|
|
setup may be advised.
|
|
|
|
The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
|
|
mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
|
|
value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
|
|
In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
|
|
If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
|
|
will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
|
|
the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
|
|
column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
|
|
an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
|
|
option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
|
|
appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
|
|
then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
|
|
|
|
Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
|
|
with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
|
|
these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
|
|
down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
|
|
|
|
@node Relative timer, , Effort estimates, Dates and Times
|
|
@section Taking notes with a relative timer
|
|
@cindex relative timer
|
|
|
|
When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
|
|
be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
|
|
such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x .
|
|
@item C-c C-x .
|
|
Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
|
|
timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
|
|
restarted.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x -
|
|
@item C-c C-x -
|
|
Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
|
|
argument, first reset the timer to 0.
|
|
@kindex M-@key{RET}
|
|
@item M-@key{RET}
|
|
Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
|
|
new timer items.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x ,
|
|
@item C-c C-x ,
|
|
Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused.
|
|
@c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
|
|
@item C-u C-c C-x ,
|
|
Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
|
|
old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x 0
|
|
@item C-c C-x 0
|
|
Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
|
|
timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
|
|
specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
|
|
default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
|
|
restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
|
|
prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
|
|
by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
|
|
not started at exactly the right moment.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
|
|
@chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
|
|
@cindex capture
|
|
|
|
An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
|
|
capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
|
|
Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
|
|
related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
|
|
system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
|
|
trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Capture:: Capturing new stuff
|
|
* Attachments:: Add files to tasks
|
|
* RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
|
|
* Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
|
|
* Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
|
|
* Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
|
|
@section Capture
|
|
@cindex capture
|
|
|
|
Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
|
|
excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
|
|
for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org-mode for
|
|
backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
|
|
for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
|
|
|
|
The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
|
|
users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
|
|
@example
|
|
@kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
|
|
customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
|
|
customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
|
|
you are familiar with the new mechanism.
|
|
|
|
Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
|
|
flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
|
|
does enhance it with templates and more.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
|
|
* Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
|
|
* Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
|
|
@subsection Setting up capture
|
|
|
|
The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
|
|
a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
|
|
suggestion.} for capturing new material.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-default-notes-file
|
|
@example
|
|
(setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
|
|
(define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
|
|
@subsection Using capture
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c c
|
|
@item C-c c
|
|
Call the command @code{org-capture}. If you have templates defined
|
|
@pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for selection or use
|
|
a new Org outline node as the default template. It will insert the template
|
|
into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer narrowed to this new
|
|
node. You may then insert the information you want.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer,
|
|
@kbd{C-c C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture
|
|
process, so that you can resume your work without further distraction.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-w
|
|
@item C-c C-w
|
|
Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
|
|
a different place.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-k
|
|
@item C-c C-k
|
|
Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
|
|
the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
|
|
the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
|
|
rather than to the current date.
|
|
|
|
@node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
|
|
@subsection Capture templates
|
|
@cindex templates, for Capture
|
|
|
|
You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
|
|
for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
|
|
through the customize interface.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c c C
|
|
@item C-c c C
|
|
Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
|
|
an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
|
|
entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
|
|
your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
|
|
@file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
|
|
would look like:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
(setq org-capture-templates
|
|
'(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
|
|
"* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
|
|
("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
|
|
"* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
|
|
for you like this:
|
|
@example
|
|
* TODO
|
|
[[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
|
|
the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
|
|
extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
|
|
the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
|
|
place where you started the capture process.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
|
|
* Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
|
|
@subsubsection Template elements
|
|
|
|
Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
|
|
@code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
|
|
|
|
@table @var
|
|
@item keys
|
|
The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
|
|
only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
|
|
single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
|
|
several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
|
|
in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
|
|
prefix key, for example
|
|
@example
|
|
("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
|
|
be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
|
|
|
|
@item description
|
|
A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
|
|
selection.
|
|
|
|
@item type
|
|
The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item entry
|
|
An Org-mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the
|
|
target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org-mode
|
|
file.
|
|
@item item
|
|
A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
|
|
location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
|
|
@item checkitem
|
|
A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
|
|
default template.
|
|
@item table-line
|
|
a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
|
|
line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
|
|
@code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
|
|
@item plain
|
|
Text to be inserted as it is.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item target
|
|
@vindex org-default-notes-file
|
|
Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org-mode
|
|
files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
|
|
node, other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
|
|
node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
|
|
the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}.
|
|
|
|
Valid values are:
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item (file "path/to/file")
|
|
Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
|
|
|
|
@item (id "id of existing org entry")
|
|
Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
|
|
|
|
@item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
|
|
Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
|
|
|
|
@item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
|
|
For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
|
|
|
|
@item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
|
|
Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
|
|
|
|
@item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
|
|
Will create a heading in a date tree.
|
|
|
|
@item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
|
|
A function to find the right location in the file.
|
|
|
|
@item (clock)
|
|
File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
|
|
|
|
@item (function function-finding-location)
|
|
Most general way, write your own function to find both
|
|
file and location.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@item template
|
|
The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
|
|
appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
|
|
escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
|
|
capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
|
|
using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
|
|
more details.
|
|
|
|
@item properties
|
|
The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
|
|
Recognized properties are:
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item :prepend
|
|
Normally new captured information will be appended at
|
|
the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
|
|
Setting this property will change that.
|
|
|
|
@item :immediate-finish
|
|
When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
|
|
file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
|
|
information that can be added automatically.
|
|
|
|
@item :empty-lines
|
|
Set this to the number of lines to insert
|
|
before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
|
|
|
|
@item :clock-in
|
|
Start the clock in this item.
|
|
|
|
@item :clock-resume
|
|
If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
|
|
with the capture.
|
|
|
|
@item :unnarrowed
|
|
Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
|
|
narrow it so that you only see the new material.
|
|
@end table
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
|
|
@subsubsection Template expansion
|
|
|
|
In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
|
|
these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
|
|
dynamic insertion of content:
|
|
|
|
@comment SJE: should these sentences terminate in period?
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
%^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
|
|
@r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
|
|
@r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
|
|
@r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
|
|
%a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
|
|
%A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
|
|
%i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
|
|
@r{region is active.}
|
|
@r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
|
|
%t @r{timestamp, date only}
|
|
%T @r{timestamp with date and time}
|
|
%u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps}
|
|
%^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
|
|
@r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
|
|
%n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
|
|
%c @r{Current kill ring head.}
|
|
%x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
|
|
%^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
|
|
%^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
|
|
%k @r{title of the currently clocked task}
|
|
%K @r{link to the currently clocked task}
|
|
%^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
|
|
%^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
|
|
%^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}}
|
|
%:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
|
|
%[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}}
|
|
%(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result}
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
For specific link types, the following keywords will be
|
|
defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
|
|
hyperlink types}), any property you store with
|
|
@code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
|
|
similar way.}:
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
Link type | Available keywords
|
|
-------------------+----------------------------------------------
|
|
bbdb | %:name %:company
|
|
bbdb | %::server %:port %:nick
|
|
vm, wl, mh, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
|
|
| %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
|
|
| %:to %:toname %:toaddress
|
|
| %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
|
|
gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
|
|
w3, w3m | %:url
|
|
info | %:file %:node
|
|
calendar | %:date
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
To place the cursor after template expansion use:
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
%? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
|
|
@section Attachments
|
|
@cindex attachments
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-attach-directory
|
|
It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
|
|
Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
|
|
Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
|
|
files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
|
|
source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
|
|
which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
|
|
uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
|
|
located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
|
|
your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
|
|
directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
|
|
to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
|
|
@code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
|
|
The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
|
|
|
|
In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
|
|
choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
|
|
directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
|
|
directory.
|
|
|
|
@noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a
|
|
@item C-c C-a
|
|
The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
|
|
keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
|
|
to select a command:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a a
|
|
@item a
|
|
@vindex org-attach-method
|
|
Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
|
|
will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
|
|
Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a m
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a l
|
|
@item c/m/l
|
|
Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
|
|
Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a n
|
|
@item n
|
|
Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a z
|
|
@item z
|
|
Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
|
|
attachments yourself.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a o
|
|
@item o
|
|
@vindex org-file-apps
|
|
Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
|
|
file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
|
|
For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
|
|
(@pxref{Handling links}).
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a O
|
|
@item O
|
|
Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a f
|
|
@item f
|
|
Open the current task's attachment directory.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a F
|
|
@item F
|
|
Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a d
|
|
@item d
|
|
Select and delete a single attachment.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a D
|
|
@item D
|
|
Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
|
|
@command{dired} and delete from there.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a s
|
|
@item C-c C-a s
|
|
@cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
|
|
Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
|
|
putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a i
|
|
@item C-c C-a i
|
|
@cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
|
|
Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
|
|
same directory for attachments as the parent does.
|
|
@end table
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
|
|
@section RSS feeds
|
|
@cindex RSS feeds
|
|
@cindex Atom feeds
|
|
|
|
Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
|
|
Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
|
|
podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
|
|
web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
|
|
@code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
|
|
information. Here is just an example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
(setq org-feed-alist
|
|
'(("Slashdot"
|
|
"http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
|
|
"~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
will configure that new items from the feed provided by
|
|
@code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
|
|
@file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
|
|
the following command is used:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x g
|
|
@item C-c C-x g
|
|
Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
|
|
them.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x G
|
|
@item C-c C-x G
|
|
Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
|
|
it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
|
|
adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
|
|
list of drawers in that file:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
|
|
@file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
|
|
|
|
@node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
|
|
@section Protocols for external access
|
|
@cindex protocols, for external access
|
|
@cindex emacsserver
|
|
|
|
You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
|
|
are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
|
|
configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
|
|
Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
|
|
could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
|
|
a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
|
|
@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
|
|
documentation and setup instructions.
|
|
|
|
@node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
|
|
@section Refiling notes
|
|
@cindex refiling notes
|
|
|
|
When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
|
|
into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
|
|
right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
|
|
process, you can use the following special command:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-w
|
|
@item C-c C-w
|
|
@vindex org-reverse-note-order
|
|
@vindex org-refile-targets
|
|
@vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
|
|
@vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
|
|
@vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
|
|
@vindex org-log-refile
|
|
@vindex org-refile-use-cache
|
|
Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
|
|
for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
|
|
all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
|
|
Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
|
|
last subitem.@*
|
|
By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
|
|
targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
|
|
See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
|
|
select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
|
|
the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
|
|
@code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
|
|
create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
|
|
variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
|
|
When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
|
|
@code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
|
|
and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a time stamp or a note will be
|
|
recorded when an entry has been refiled.
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c C-w
|
|
@item C-u C-c C-w
|
|
Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
|
|
@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-w
|
|
@item C-u C-u C-c C-w
|
|
Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
|
|
@item C-2 C-c C-w
|
|
Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
|
|
@item C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w
|
|
Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
|
|
setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command seen new possible
|
|
targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
|
|
@section Archiving
|
|
@cindex archiving
|
|
|
|
When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
|
|
to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
|
|
agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
|
|
searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-a
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-a
|
|
@vindex org-archive-default-command
|
|
Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
|
|
@code{org-archive-default-command}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
|
|
* Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
|
|
@subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
|
|
@cindex external archiving
|
|
|
|
The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
|
|
the archive file.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c $
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-s
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-s@ @r{or short} @ C-c $
|
|
@vindex org-archive-location
|
|
Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
|
|
given by @code{org-archive-location}.
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-s
|
|
@item C-u C-c C-x C-s
|
|
Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
|
|
the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
|
|
If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
|
|
location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
|
|
is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@cindex archive locations
|
|
The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
|
|
current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
|
|
current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
|
|
see the documentation string of the variable
|
|
@code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
|
|
setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
|
|
the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
|
|
each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
|
|
such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
|
|
using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
|
|
with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
|
|
setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+ARCHIVE
|
|
@example
|
|
#+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@cindex property, ARCHIVE
|
|
@noindent
|
|
If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
|
|
or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
|
|
location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-archive-save-context-info
|
|
When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
|
|
record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
|
|
outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
|
|
@code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
|
|
added.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
|
|
@subsection Internal archiving
|
|
|
|
If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
|
|
moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
|
|
|
|
A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
|
|
its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
|
|
It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
|
|
command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
|
|
subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
|
|
@code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
|
|
@code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
|
|
During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
|
|
archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
|
|
@code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
|
|
During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
|
|
archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
|
|
@code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
|
|
be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
|
|
temporarily included.
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
|
|
Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
|
|
is. Configure the details using the variable
|
|
@code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
|
|
Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
|
|
@code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x a
|
|
@item C-c C-x a
|
|
Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
|
|
the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
|
|
hidden.
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c C-x a
|
|
@item C-u C-c C-x a
|
|
Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
|
|
To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
|
|
found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
|
|
cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
|
|
level 1 trees will be checked.
|
|
@kindex C-@kbd{TAB}
|
|
@item C-@kbd{TAB}
|
|
Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x A
|
|
@item C-c C-x A
|
|
Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
|
|
the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
|
|
entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
|
|
original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
|
|
outline.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
|
|
@chapter Agenda views
|
|
@cindex agenda views
|
|
|
|
Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
|
|
tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
|
|
files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
|
|
important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
|
|
sorted and displayed in an organized way.
|
|
|
|
Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
|
|
in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
|
|
for specific dates,
|
|
@item
|
|
a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
|
|
action items,
|
|
@item
|
|
a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
|
|
TODO state associated with them,
|
|
@item
|
|
a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
|
|
in time-sorted view,
|
|
@item
|
|
a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
|
|
that contain specified keywords,
|
|
@item
|
|
a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
|
|
along, and
|
|
@item
|
|
@emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
|
|
views.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
|
|
buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
|
|
corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
|
|
edit these files remotely.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-window-setup
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
|
|
Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
|
|
window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
|
|
@code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
|
|
@code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
|
|
* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
|
|
* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
|
|
* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
|
|
* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
|
|
* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
|
|
* Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
|
|
* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
|
|
@section Agenda files
|
|
@cindex agenda files
|
|
@cindex files for agenda
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-files
|
|
The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
|
|
files}, the files listed in the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
|
|
list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
|
|
maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
|
|
all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
|
|
of the list.
|
|
|
|
Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
|
|
be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
|
|
@kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
|
|
the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
|
|
dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
|
|
the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
|
|
|
|
@cindex files, adding to agenda list
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c [
|
|
@item C-c [
|
|
Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
|
|
the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
|
|
the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
|
|
@kindex C-c ]
|
|
@item C-c ]
|
|
Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
|
|
@kindex C-,
|
|
@kindex C-'
|
|
@item C-,
|
|
@itemx C-'
|
|
Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
|
|
@kindex M-x org-iswitchb
|
|
@item M-x org-iswitchb
|
|
Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
|
|
buffers.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
|
|
to visit any of them.
|
|
|
|
If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
|
|
this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
|
|
file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
|
|
you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
|
|
(@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
|
|
extended period, use the following commands:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x <
|
|
@item C-c C-x <
|
|
Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
|
|
prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
|
|
the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
|
|
effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
|
|
or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
|
|
agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x >
|
|
@item C-c C-x >
|
|
Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
|
|
the Speedbar frame:
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex <
|
|
@item < @r{in the speedbar frame}
|
|
Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
|
|
in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
|
|
If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
|
|
effect immediately.
|
|
@kindex >
|
|
@item > @r{in the speedbar frame}
|
|
Lift the restriction.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
|
|
@section The agenda dispatcher
|
|
@cindex agenda dispatcher
|
|
@cindex dispatching agenda commands
|
|
The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
|
|
global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
|
|
following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
|
|
is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
|
|
pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
|
|
command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@item a
|
|
Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
|
|
@item t @r{/} T
|
|
Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
|
|
@item m @r{/} M
|
|
Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
|
|
tags and properties}).
|
|
@item L
|
|
Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
|
|
@item s
|
|
Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
|
|
and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
|
|
@item /
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
|
|
Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
|
|
the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
|
|
uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
|
|
used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
|
|
1.
|
|
@item # @r{/} !
|
|
Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
|
|
@item <
|
|
Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
|
|
compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
|
|
buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
|
|
selecting the command.
|
|
@item < <
|
|
If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
|
|
the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
|
|
backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
|
|
current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
|
|
character selecting the command.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
|
|
dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
|
|
possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
|
|
blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
|
|
a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
|
|
|
|
@node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
|
|
@section The built-in agenda views
|
|
|
|
In this section we describe the built-in views.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
|
|
* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
|
|
* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
|
|
* Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
|
|
* Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
|
|
* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
|
|
@subsection The weekly/daily agenda
|
|
@cindex agenda
|
|
@cindex weekly agenda
|
|
@cindex daily agenda
|
|
|
|
The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
|
|
paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@cindex org-agenda, command
|
|
@kindex C-c a a
|
|
@item C-c a a
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-ndays
|
|
Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
|
|
shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
|
|
compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
|
|
listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
|
|
list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
|
|
C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed (see also the
|
|
variable @code{org-agenda-ndays})
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
|
|
change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
|
|
The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
|
|
commands}.
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
|
|
@cindex calendar integration
|
|
@cindex diary integration
|
|
|
|
Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
|
|
calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
|
|
countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
|
|
anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
|
|
(weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
|
|
Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
|
|
the diary.
|
|
|
|
In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's
|
|
agenda, you only need to customize the variable
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
|
|
entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
|
|
agenda buffer created by Org-mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
|
|
@key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
|
|
file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
|
|
insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
|
|
well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
|
|
Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
|
|
calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
|
|
between calendar and agenda.
|
|
|
|
If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
|
|
faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
|
|
the entries into an Org file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp
|
|
entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
|
|
creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
|
|
the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
|
|
the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
|
|
will be made in the agenda:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* Birthdays and similar stuff
|
|
#+CATEGORY: Holiday
|
|
%%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
|
|
#+CATEGORY: Ann
|
|
%%(diary-anniversary 5 14 1956)@footnote{Note that the order of the arguments (month, day, year) depends on the setting of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
|
|
%%(diary-anniversary 10 2 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
|
|
@cindex BBDB, anniversaries
|
|
@cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
|
|
|
|
If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
|
|
very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
|
|
separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
|
|
anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
|
|
following to one your your agenda files:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* Anniversaries
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:CATEGORY: Anniv
|
|
:END:
|
|
%%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
|
|
you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
|
|
record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD}, followed by a
|
|
space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or @samp{wedding}, or
|
|
a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to @samp{birthday}.
|
|
Here are a few examples, the header for the file @file{org-bbdb.el} contains
|
|
more detailed information.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
1973-06-22
|
|
1955-08-02 wedding
|
|
2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
|
|
session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
|
|
hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
|
|
faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
|
|
in an Org or Diary file.
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Appointment reminders
|
|
@cindex @file{appt.el}
|
|
@cindex appointment reminders
|
|
|
|
Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
|
|
the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
|
|
@code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
|
|
list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
|
|
or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
|
|
|
|
@node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
|
|
@subsection The global TODO list
|
|
@cindex global TODO list
|
|
@cindex TODO list, global
|
|
|
|
The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
|
|
collected into a single place.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c a t
|
|
@item C-c a t
|
|
Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
|
|
files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
|
|
items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
|
|
@code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
|
|
entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
|
|
@kindex C-c a T
|
|
@item C-c a T
|
|
@cindex TODO keyword matching
|
|
@vindex org-todo-keywords
|
|
Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
|
|
also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
|
|
prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
|
|
separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
|
|
prefix, the nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
|
|
@kindex r
|
|
The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
|
|
a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
|
|
for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
|
|
keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
|
|
Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
|
|
search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
|
|
TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
|
|
TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
|
|
Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
|
|
keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
|
|
it more compact:
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
|
|
Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
|
|
have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
|
|
Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
|
|
@code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines}, and/or
|
|
@code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the
|
|
global TODO list.
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
|
|
TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
|
|
such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
|
|
and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
|
|
@subsection Matching tags and properties
|
|
@cindex matching, of tags
|
|
@cindex matching, of properties
|
|
@cindex tags view
|
|
@cindex match view
|
|
|
|
If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
|
|
or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
|
|
based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
|
|
syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
|
|
m}.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c a m
|
|
@item C-c a m
|
|
Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
|
|
command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
|
|
expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
|
|
@samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
|
|
define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
|
|
@kindex C-c a M
|
|
@item C-c a M
|
|
@vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
|
|
Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
|
|
not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
|
|
@code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
|
|
see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
|
|
specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
|
|
@ref{Tag searches}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
|
|
commands}.
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Match syntax
|
|
|
|
@cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
|
|
A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
|
|
OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
|
|
not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
|
|
expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
|
|
VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
|
|
may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
|
|
sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
|
|
@samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
|
|
|
|
@table @samp
|
|
@item +work-boss
|
|
Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
|
|
@samp{:boss:}.
|
|
@item work|laptop
|
|
Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
|
|
@item work|laptop+night
|
|
Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
|
|
@samp{:night:}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@cindex regular expressions, with tags search
|
|
Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
|
|
braces. For example,
|
|
@samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
|
|
@samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
|
|
@cindex level, require for tags/property match
|
|
@cindex category, require for tags/property match
|
|
@vindex org-odd-levels-only
|
|
You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
|
|
time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
|
|
properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
|
|
example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
|
|
entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
|
|
So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
|
|
that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
|
|
DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
|
|
count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
|
|
|
|
Here are more examples:
|
|
@table @samp
|
|
@item work+TODO="WAITING"
|
|
Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
|
|
keyword @samp{WAITING}.
|
|
@item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
|
|
Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
|
|
the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
+work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
|
|
+With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item
|
|
If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
|
|
and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
|
|
@samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
|
|
a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
|
|
brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
|
|
assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
|
|
comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
|
|
are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
|
|
@code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
|
|
specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
|
|
@code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
|
|
respectively, can be used.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the comparison value is enclosed
|
|
in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
|
|
regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
|
|
match.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
|
|
not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
|
|
@samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
|
|
property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
|
|
matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
|
|
on or after October 11, 2008.
|
|
|
|
Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
|
|
other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
|
|
price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
|
|
again.
|
|
|
|
You can configure Org-mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
|
|
beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
|
|
inheritance}, for details.
|
|
|
|
For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
|
|
different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
|
|
tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
|
|
connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
|
|
expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
|
|
tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
|
|
several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
|
|
However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
|
|
make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
|
|
(resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
|
|
part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
|
|
not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
|
|
|
|
@table @samp
|
|
@item work/WAITING
|
|
Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
|
|
@item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
|
|
Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
|
|
nor @samp{NEXT}
|
|
@item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
|
|
Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
|
|
@samp{NEXT}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
|
|
@subsection Timeline for a single file
|
|
@cindex timeline, single file
|
|
@cindex time-sorted view
|
|
|
|
The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode
|
|
file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
|
|
to give an overview over events in a project.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c a L
|
|
@item C-c a L
|
|
Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
|
|
When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
|
|
(scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
|
|
@ref{Agenda commands}.
|
|
|
|
@node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
|
|
@subsection Search view
|
|
@cindex search view
|
|
@cindex text search
|
|
@cindex searching, for text
|
|
|
|
This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org-mode entries.
|
|
It is particularly useful to find notes.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c a s
|
|
@item C-c a s
|
|
This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
|
|
or specific words using a boolean logic.
|
|
@end table
|
|
For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
|
|
that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
|
|
separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
|
|
Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
|
|
logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
|
|
will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
|
|
and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
|
|
not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
|
|
exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
|
|
word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
|
|
the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
|
|
Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
|
|
the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
|
|
|
|
@node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
|
|
@subsection Stuck projects
|
|
|
|
If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
|
|
work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
|
|
that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
|
|
has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
|
|
Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
|
|
projects and define next actions for them.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c a #
|
|
@item C-c a #
|
|
List projects that are stuck.
|
|
@kindex C-c a !
|
|
@item C-c a !
|
|
@vindex org-stuck-projects
|
|
Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
|
|
project is and how to find it.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
|
|
work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
|
|
level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
|
|
one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
|
|
|
|
Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify
|
|
projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
|
|
indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
|
|
assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
|
|
and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
|
|
is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
|
|
contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
|
|
either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
|
|
with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
|
|
@samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
|
|
IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
|
|
correct customization for this is
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-stuck-projects
|
|
'("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
|
|
"\\<IGNORE\\>"))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
|
|
will still be searched for stuck projects.
|
|
|
|
@node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
|
|
@section Presentation and sorting
|
|
@cindex presentation, of agenda items
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
|
|
Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares
|
|
the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
|
|
starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
|
|
(@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
|
|
customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
|
|
The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
|
|
associated with the item.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
|
|
* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
|
|
* Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
|
|
@subsection Categories
|
|
|
|
@cindex category
|
|
The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
|
|
the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
|
|
specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
|
|
backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
|
|
such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
|
|
The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
|
|
line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
|
|
incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
|
|
method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
|
|
property.}:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+CATEGORY: Thesis
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@cindex property, CATEGORY
|
|
If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
|
|
(sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
|
|
special category you want to apply as the value.
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
|
|
longer than 10 characters.
|
|
|
|
@node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
|
|
@subsection Time-of-day specifications
|
|
@cindex time-of-day specification
|
|
|
|
Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
|
|
time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
|
|
agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
|
|
ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
|
|
@c
|
|
@w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
|
|
|
|
In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
|
|
plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
|
|
integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
|
|
specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
|
|
|
|
For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a
|
|
standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
|
|
the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
|
|
12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
|
|
19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
|
|
20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@cindex time grid
|
|
If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
|
|
timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
8:00...... ------------------
|
|
8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
|
|
10:00...... ------------------
|
|
12:00...... ------------------
|
|
12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
|
|
14:00...... ------------------
|
|
16:00...... ------------------
|
|
18:00...... ------------------
|
|
19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
|
|
20:00...... ------------------
|
|
20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-time-grid
|
|
The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
|
|
@code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
|
|
|
|
@node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
|
|
@subsection Sorting of agenda items
|
|
@cindex sorting, of agenda items
|
|
@cindex priorities, of agenda items
|
|
Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
|
|
done depends on the type of view.
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-files
|
|
For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
|
|
default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
|
|
time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
|
|
of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
|
|
grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
|
|
Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
|
|
which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
|
|
for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
|
|
overdue scheduled or deadline items.
|
|
@item
|
|
For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
|
|
each category, sorting takes place according to priority
|
|
(@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
|
|
priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
|
|
or scheduled date.
|
|
@item
|
|
For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
|
|
sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
|
|
Sorting can be customized using the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
|
|
the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
|
|
|
|
@node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
|
|
@section Commands in the agenda buffer
|
|
@cindex commands, in agenda buffer
|
|
|
|
Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
|
|
file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
|
|
buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
|
|
original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
|
|
the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
|
|
removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
|
|
|
|
Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
|
|
the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@tsubheading{Motion}
|
|
@cindex motion commands in agenda
|
|
@kindex n
|
|
@item n
|
|
Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
|
|
@kindex p
|
|
@item p
|
|
Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
|
|
@tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
|
|
@kindex mouse-3
|
|
@kindex @key{SPC}
|
|
@item mouse-3
|
|
@itemx @key{SPC}
|
|
Display the original location of the item in another window.
|
|
With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
|
|
outline, not only the heading.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex L
|
|
@item L
|
|
Display original location and recenter that window.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex mouse-2
|
|
@kindex mouse-1
|
|
@kindex @key{TAB}
|
|
@item mouse-2
|
|
@itemx mouse-1
|
|
@itemx @key{TAB}
|
|
Go to the original location of the item in another window. Under Emacs
|
|
22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also works for this.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex @key{RET}
|
|
@itemx @key{RET}
|
|
Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex F
|
|
@item F
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
|
|
Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
|
|
the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
|
|
location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
|
|
agenda buffers can be set with the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x b
|
|
@item C-c C-x b
|
|
Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
|
|
numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
|
|
negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
|
|
previously used indirect buffer.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-o
|
|
@item C-c C-o
|
|
Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
|
|
text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
|
|
will be followed without a selection prompt.
|
|
|
|
@tsubheading{Change display}
|
|
@cindex display changing, in agenda
|
|
@kindex o
|
|
@item o
|
|
Delete other windows.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex v d
|
|
@kindex d
|
|
@kindex v w
|
|
@kindex w
|
|
@kindex v m
|
|
@kindex v y
|
|
@item v d @ @r{or short} @ d
|
|
@itemx v w @ @r{or short} @ w
|
|
@itemx v m
|
|
@itemx v y
|
|
Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
|
|
this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
|
|
month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
|
|
A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
|
|
of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
|
|
@kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
|
|
setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
|
|
argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
|
|
2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
|
|
be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex f
|
|
@item f
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-ndays
|
|
Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
|
|
For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
|
|
With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex b
|
|
@item b
|
|
Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex .
|
|
@item .
|
|
Go to today.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex j
|
|
@item j
|
|
Prompt for a date and go there.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex D
|
|
@item D
|
|
Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex v l
|
|
@kindex v L
|
|
@kindex l
|
|
@item v l @ @r{or short} @ l
|
|
@vindex org-log-done
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
|
|
Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
|
|
logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
|
|
entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
|
|
types that should be included in log mode using the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
|
|
all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
|
|
prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
|
|
@kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex v [
|
|
@kindex [
|
|
@item v [ @ @r{or short} @ [
|
|
Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
|
|
agenda and timeline views.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex v a
|
|
@kindex v A
|
|
@item v a
|
|
@itemx v A
|
|
Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
|
|
@code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
|
|
capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
|
|
press @kbd{v a} again.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex v R
|
|
@kindex R
|
|
@item v R @ @r{or short} @ R
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
|
|
Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
|
|
always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
|
|
covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
|
|
agenda buffers can be set with the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex v E
|
|
@kindex E
|
|
@item v E @ @r{or short} @ E
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
|
|
Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
|
|
outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
|
|
The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
|
|
prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex G
|
|
@item G
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-time-grid
|
|
Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
|
|
@code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex r
|
|
@item r
|
|
Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
|
|
modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
|
|
@kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
|
|
argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
|
|
keyword.
|
|
@kindex g
|
|
@item g
|
|
Same as @kbd{r}.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex s
|
|
@kindex C-x C-s
|
|
@item s
|
|
@itemx C-x C-s
|
|
Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
|
|
IDs.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-c
|
|
@vindex org-columns-default-format
|
|
Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
|
|
view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
|
|
point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
|
|
that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
|
|
@code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
|
|
@code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x >
|
|
@item C-c C-x >
|
|
Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
|
|
file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
|
|
|
|
@tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
|
|
@cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
|
|
@cindex tag filtering, in agenda
|
|
@cindex effort filtering, in agenda
|
|
@cindex query editing, in agenda
|
|
|
|
@kindex /
|
|
@item /
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
|
|
Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
|
|
The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
|
|
very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
|
|
having to recreate the agenda@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
|
|
binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
|
|
filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
|
|
refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
|
|
the entire agenda view - in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
|
|
global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
|
|
|
|
You will be prompted for a tag selection letter, SPC will mean any tag at
|
|
all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
|
|
tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
|
|
then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
|
|
with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
|
|
@kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
|
|
If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
|
|
will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
|
|
Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
|
|
immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
|
|
In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set-up allowed
|
|
efforts globally, for example
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-global-properties
|
|
'(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
|
|
@kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
|
|
estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
|
|
The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
|
|
or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
|
|
as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
|
|
directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
|
|
application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
|
|
according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
|
|
for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
|
|
|
|
Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
|
|
that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
|
|
automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
|
|
as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
|
|
say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
|
|
@code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
|
|
calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
|
|
Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
@group
|
|
(defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
|
|
(and (cond
|
|
((string= tag "Net")
|
|
(/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
|
|
"-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
|
|
((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
|
|
(let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
|
|
(or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
|
|
(concat "-" tag)))
|
|
|
|
(setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@kindex \
|
|
@item \
|
|
Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
|
|
prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
|
|
the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
|
|
@kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
|
|
|
|
@kindex [
|
|
@kindex ]
|
|
@kindex @{
|
|
@kindex @}
|
|
@item [ ] @{ @}
|
|
@table @i
|
|
@item @r{in} search view
|
|
add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
|
|
(@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
|
|
add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
|
|
term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
|
|
negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
|
|
selected.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@page
|
|
@tsubheading{Remote editing}
|
|
@cindex remote editing, from agenda
|
|
|
|
@item 0-9
|
|
Digit argument.
|
|
@c
|
|
@cindex undoing remote-editing events
|
|
@cindex remote editing, undo
|
|
@kindex C-_
|
|
@item C-_
|
|
Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
|
|
both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex t
|
|
@item t
|
|
Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
|
|
original org file.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-S-@key{right}
|
|
@kindex C-S-@key{left}
|
|
@item C-S-@key{right}@r{/}@key{left}
|
|
Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-k
|
|
@item C-k
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
|
|
Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
|
|
to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
|
|
is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
|
|
variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-w
|
|
@item C-c C-w
|
|
Refile the entry at point.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-a
|
|
@kindex a
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-a @ @r{or short} @ a
|
|
@vindex org-archive-default-command
|
|
Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
|
|
archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
|
|
@code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x a
|
|
@item C-c C-x a
|
|
Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x A
|
|
@item C-c C-x A
|
|
Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
|
|
sibling}.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex $
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-s
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-s @ @r{or short} @ $
|
|
Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
|
|
entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
|
|
different file.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex T
|
|
@item T
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
|
|
Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
|
|
turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
|
|
tags of a headline occasionally.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex :
|
|
@item :
|
|
Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
|
|
agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex ,
|
|
@item ,
|
|
Set the priority for the current item. Org-mode prompts for the
|
|
priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the priority cookie
|
|
is removed from the entry.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex P
|
|
@item P
|
|
Display weighted priority of current item.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex +
|
|
@kindex S-@key{up}
|
|
@item +
|
|
@itemx S-@key{up}
|
|
Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
|
|
the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
|
|
key for this.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex -
|
|
@kindex S-@key{down}
|
|
@item -
|
|
@itemx S-@key{down}
|
|
Decrease the priority of the current item.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-z
|
|
@kindex z
|
|
@item z @ @r{or also} @ C-c C-z
|
|
@vindex org-log-into-drawer
|
|
Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then files to the
|
|
same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
|
|
@code{org-log-into-drawer}, this maybe inside a drawer.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-a
|
|
@item C-c C-a
|
|
Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-s
|
|
@item C-c C-s
|
|
Schedule this item, with prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c C-d
|
|
@item C-c C-d
|
|
Set a deadline for this item, with prefix arg remove the deadline.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex k
|
|
@item k
|
|
Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
|
|
This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
|
|
additional key:
|
|
@example
|
|
m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
|
|
@r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
|
|
d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
|
|
s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
|
|
r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
|
|
command.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex S-@key{right}
|
|
@item S-@key{right}
|
|
Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
|
|
future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
|
|
example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
|
|
@kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
|
|
command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
|
|
a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
|
|
is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
|
|
in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex S-@key{left}
|
|
@item S-@key{left}
|
|
Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
|
|
into the past.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex >
|
|
@item >
|
|
Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
|
|
been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex I
|
|
@item I
|
|
Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
|
|
is stopped first.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex O
|
|
@item O
|
|
Stop the previously started clock.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex X
|
|
@item X
|
|
Cancel the currently running clock.
|
|
|
|
@kindex J
|
|
@item J
|
|
Jump to the running clock in another window.
|
|
|
|
@tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
|
|
@cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
|
|
|
|
@kindex m
|
|
@item m
|
|
Mark the entry at point for bulk action.
|
|
|
|
@kindex u
|
|
@item u
|
|
Unmark entry for bulk action.
|
|
|
|
@kindex U
|
|
@item U
|
|
Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
|
|
|
|
@kindex B
|
|
@item B
|
|
Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
|
|
another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
|
|
will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
|
|
these special timestamps.
|
|
@example
|
|
r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
|
|
@r{will no longer be in the agenda, refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
|
|
$ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
|
|
A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
|
|
t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
|
|
@r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
|
|
@r{suppressing logging notes (but not time stamps).}
|
|
+ @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
|
|
- @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
|
|
s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
|
|
@r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
|
|
@r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
|
|
d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
@tsubheading{Calendar commands}
|
|
@cindex calendar commands, from agenda
|
|
@kindex c
|
|
@item c
|
|
Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
|
|
@c
|
|
@item c
|
|
When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the
|
|
date at the cursor.
|
|
@c
|
|
@cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
|
|
@kindex i
|
|
@item i
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-diary-file
|
|
Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
|
|
block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
|
|
file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
|
|
@code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
|
|
command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
|
|
you can add the entry.
|
|
|
|
If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
|
|
Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
|
|
entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
|
|
easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
|
|
built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
|
|
top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text - if you specify
|
|
it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
|
|
interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
|
|
text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
|
|
entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex M
|
|
@item M
|
|
Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex S
|
|
@item S
|
|
Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
|
|
with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C
|
|
@item C
|
|
Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
|
|
calendars.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex H
|
|
@item H
|
|
Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
|
|
|
|
@item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
|
|
Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
|
|
This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
|
|
|
|
@tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
|
|
@kindex C-x C-w
|
|
@item C-x C-w
|
|
@cindex exporting agenda views
|
|
@cindex agenda views, exporting
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
|
|
Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
|
|
file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
|
|
@file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
|
|
and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
|
|
argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
|
|
for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
|
|
|
|
@tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
|
|
@kindex q
|
|
@item q
|
|
Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex x
|
|
@cindex agenda files, removing buffers
|
|
@item x
|
|
Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
|
|
for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
|
|
visit Org files will not be removed.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
|
|
@section Custom agenda views
|
|
@cindex custom agenda views
|
|
@cindex agenda views, custom
|
|
|
|
Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
|
|
frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
|
|
agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
|
|
dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Storing searches:: Type once, use often
|
|
* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
|
|
* Setting Options:: Changing the rules
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
|
|
@subsection Storing searches
|
|
|
|
The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
|
|
shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
|
|
buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
|
|
buffer).
|
|
@kindex C-c a C
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
Custom commands are configured in the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
|
|
example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
|
|
Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
|
|
search types:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
@group
|
|
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
'(("w" todo "WAITING")
|
|
("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
|
|
("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
|
|
("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
|
|
("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
|
|
("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
|
|
("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
|
|
("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
|
|
("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
|
|
("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
|
|
after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
|
|
Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
|
|
similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
|
|
first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
|
|
prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
|
|
inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
|
|
parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
|
|
expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
|
|
therefore define:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@item C-c a w
|
|
as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
|
|
keyword
|
|
@item C-c a W
|
|
as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
|
|
results as a sparse tree
|
|
@item C-c a u
|
|
as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
|
|
@samp{:urgent:}
|
|
@item C-c a v
|
|
as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
|
|
headlines that are also TODO items
|
|
@item C-c a U
|
|
as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
|
|
displaying the result as a sparse tree
|
|
@item C-c a f
|
|
to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
|
|
containing the word @samp{FIXME}
|
|
@item C-c a h
|
|
as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
|
|
additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
|
|
Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
|
|
@subsection Block agenda
|
|
@cindex block agenda
|
|
@cindex agenda, with block views
|
|
|
|
Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
|
|
the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
|
|
the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
|
|
daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
|
|
for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
|
|
matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
|
|
@code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
@group
|
|
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
'(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
|
|
((agenda "")
|
|
(tags-todo "home")
|
|
(tags "garden")))
|
|
("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
|
|
((agenda "")
|
|
(tags-todo "work")
|
|
(tags "office")))))
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
|
|
you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
|
|
your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
|
|
@samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
|
|
command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
|
|
|
|
@node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
|
|
@subsection Setting options for custom commands
|
|
@cindex options, for custom agenda views
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
|
|
and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
|
|
commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
|
|
some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
|
|
options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
|
|
right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
@group
|
|
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
'(("w" todo "WAITING"
|
|
((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
|
|
(org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
|
|
("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
|
|
((org-show-following-heading nil)
|
|
(org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
|
|
("N" search ""
|
|
((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
|
|
(org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
|
|
priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
|
|
instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
|
|
@kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
|
|
headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
|
|
will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
|
|
to only a single file.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
For command sets creating a block agenda,
|
|
@code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
|
|
options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
|
|
command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
|
|
the set. The former are just added to the command entry, the latter
|
|
must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
|
|
agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
|
|
for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
|
|
the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
|
|
@code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
@group
|
|
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
'(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
|
|
((agenda)
|
|
(tags-todo "home")
|
|
(tags "garden"
|
|
((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
|
|
((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
|
|
("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
|
|
((agenda)
|
|
(tags-todo "work")
|
|
(tags "office")))))
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
|
|
When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
|
|
fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
|
|
this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
|
|
value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
|
|
yourself.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
|
|
@section Exporting Agenda Views
|
|
@cindex agenda views, exporting
|
|
|
|
If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
|
|
version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can export custom
|
|
agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
|
|
@file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
|
|
ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
|
|
a PDF file with also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
|
|
you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-x C-w
|
|
@item C-x C-w
|
|
@cindex exporting agenda views
|
|
@cindex agenda views, exporting
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
|
|
Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
|
|
file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
|
|
@file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
|
|
@file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
|
|
@code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
|
|
for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
|
|
@vindex htmlize-output-type
|
|
@vindex ps-number-of-columns
|
|
@vindex ps-landscape-mode
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
|
|
'((ps-number-of-columns 2)
|
|
(ps-landscape-mode t)
|
|
(org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
|
|
(htmlize-output-type 'css)))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
|
|
any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
|
|
@footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
|
|
or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
|
|
them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
|
|
that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
|
|
TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
|
|
Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
|
|
as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
|
|
or absolute.
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
@group
|
|
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
'(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
|
|
("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
|
|
("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
|
|
((agenda "")
|
|
(tags-todo "home")
|
|
(tags "garden"))
|
|
nil
|
|
("~/views/home.html"))
|
|
("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
|
|
((agenda)
|
|
(tags-todo "work")
|
|
(tags "office"))
|
|
nil
|
|
("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
|
|
@file{.html}, Org-mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
|
|
the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
|
|
@file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
|
|
Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
|
|
run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
|
|
limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
|
|
extension produces a plain ASCII file.
|
|
|
|
The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
|
|
commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
|
|
Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
|
|
files in one step:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c a e
|
|
@item C-c a e
|
|
Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
|
|
them.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
|
|
set options for the export commands. For example:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
'(("X" agenda ""
|
|
((ps-number-of-columns 2)
|
|
(ps-landscape-mode t)
|
|
(org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
|
|
(org-agenda-with-colors nil)
|
|
(org-agenda-remove-tags t))
|
|
("theagenda.ps"))))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
|
|
print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
|
|
in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
|
|
the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
|
|
instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
|
|
to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
|
|
black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
|
|
@code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
|
|
in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
From the command line you may also use
|
|
@example
|
|
emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent
|
|
or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
|
|
system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
|
|
@example
|
|
emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
|
|
org-agenda-ndays 30 \
|
|
org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
|
|
org-agenda-include-diary nil \
|
|
org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
|
|
-kill
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent
|
|
which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
|
|
@file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
|
|
extent.
|
|
|
|
You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
|
|
processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
|
|
more information.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
|
|
@section Using column view in the agenda
|
|
@cindex column view, in agenda
|
|
@cindex agenda, column view
|
|
|
|
Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
|
|
properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
|
|
quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
|
|
collected by certain criteria.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-c
|
|
Turn on column view in the agenda.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
|
|
entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
|
|
This causes the following issues:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-columns-default-format
|
|
@vindex org-overriding-columns-format
|
|
Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
|
|
entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
|
|
may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
|
|
Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
|
|
currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
|
|
the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
|
|
does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
|
|
uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
|
|
If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
|
|
turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
|
|
make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
|
|
also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
|
|
values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
|
|
cover a single day, in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
|
|
vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
|
|
example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
|
|
same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
|
|
cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
|
|
some values will count double.
|
|
@item
|
|
When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
|
|
the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
|
|
the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
|
|
current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
|
|
a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
|
|
applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
|
|
clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
|
|
the agenda).
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
|
|
@chapter Markup for rich export
|
|
|
|
When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
|
|
structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
|
|
export targets like HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
|
|
Org-mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
|
|
summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
|
|
* Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
|
|
* Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
|
|
* Include files:: Include additional files into a document
|
|
* Index entries:: Making an index
|
|
* Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
|
|
* Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
|
|
@section Structural markup elements
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Document title:: Where the title is taken from
|
|
* Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
|
|
* Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
|
|
* Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
|
|
* Lists:: Lists
|
|
* Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
|
|
* Footnote markup:: Footnotes
|
|
* Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
|
|
* Horizontal rules:: Make a line
|
|
* Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
|
|
@subheading Document title
|
|
@cindex document title, markup rules
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+TITLE
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TITLE: This is the title of the document
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
|
|
non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
|
|
turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
|
|
title will be the file name without extension.
|
|
|
|
@cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
|
|
If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
|
|
of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
|
|
property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
|
|
|
|
@node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
|
|
@subheading Headings and sections
|
|
@cindex headings and sections, markup rules
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-headline-levels
|
|
The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
|
|
Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
|
|
However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
|
|
tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
|
|
levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
|
|
switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
|
|
per-file basis with a line
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+OPTIONS
|
|
@example
|
|
#+OPTIONS: H:4
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
|
|
@subheading Table of contents
|
|
@cindex table of contents, markup rules
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-toc
|
|
The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
|
|
of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
|
|
string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
|
|
location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
|
|
number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
|
|
the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
|
|
@code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
|
|
#+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
|
|
@subheading Text before the first headline
|
|
@cindex text before first headline, markup rules
|
|
@cindex #+TEXT
|
|
|
|
Org-mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
|
|
the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
|
|
you need to include literal HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
|
|
constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
|
|
Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
|
|
internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
|
|
the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
|
|
@code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
|
|
basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
|
|
@code{#+TEXT} construct:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+OPTIONS: skip:t
|
|
#+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
|
|
#+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
|
|
#+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
|
|
@subheading Lists
|
|
@cindex lists, markup rules
|
|
|
|
Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
|
|
syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
|
|
description lists.
|
|
|
|
@node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
|
|
@subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
|
|
@cindex paragraphs, markup rules
|
|
|
|
Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
|
|
a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
|
|
|
|
To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
|
|
can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_VERSE
|
|
Great clouds overhead
|
|
Tiny black birds rise and fall
|
|
Snow covers Emacs
|
|
|
|
-- AlexSchroeder
|
|
#+END_VERSE
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
|
|
as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
|
|
can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_QUOTE
|
|
Everything should be made as simple as possible,
|
|
but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
|
|
#+END_QUOTE
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_CENTER
|
|
Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
|
|
but not any simpler
|
|
#+END_CENTER
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
|
|
@subheading Footnote markup
|
|
@cindex footnotes, markup rules
|
|
@cindex @file{footnote.el}
|
|
|
|
Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported by
|
|
all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
|
|
different backends support this to varying degrees.
|
|
|
|
@node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
|
|
@subheading Emphasis and monospace
|
|
|
|
@cindex underlined text, markup rules
|
|
@cindex bold text, markup rules
|
|
@cindex italic text, markup rules
|
|
@cindex verbatim text, markup rules
|
|
@cindex code text, markup rules
|
|
@cindex strike-through text, markup rules
|
|
You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
|
|
and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
|
|
in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
|
|
syntax, it is exported verbatim.
|
|
|
|
@node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
|
|
@subheading Horizontal rules
|
|
@cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
|
|
A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
|
|
exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
|
|
|
|
@node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
|
|
@subheading Comment lines
|
|
@cindex comment lines
|
|
@cindex exporting, not
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
|
|
|
|
Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
|
|
never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
|
|
start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
|
|
@samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
|
|
@samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c ;
|
|
@item C-c ;
|
|
Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
|
|
@section Images and Tables
|
|
|
|
@cindex tables, markup rules
|
|
@cindex #+CAPTION
|
|
@cindex #+LABEL
|
|
Both the native Org-mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
|
|
the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org-mode tables,
|
|
the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
|
|
lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
|
|
a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
|
|
the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
|
|
#+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
|
|
| ... | ...|
|
|
|-----|----|
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@cindex inlined images, markup rules
|
|
Some backends (HTML, La@TeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
|
|
images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
|
|
files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
|
|
If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
|
|
cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
|
|
it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
|
|
#+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
|
|
[[./img/a.jpg]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
|
|
backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
|
|
information.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
|
|
@section Literal examples
|
|
@cindex literal examples, markup rules
|
|
@cindex code line references, markup rules
|
|
|
|
You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
|
|
markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
|
|
for source code and similar examples.
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
|
|
Some example from a text file.
|
|
#+END_EXAMPLE
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
|
|
indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
|
|
lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
|
|
example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
|
|
whitespace before the colon:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
Here is an example
|
|
: Some example from a text file.
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@cindex formatting source code, markup rules
|
|
If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
|
|
that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
|
|
look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{Currently this works for the
|
|
HTML backend, and requires the @file{htmlize.el} package version 1.34 or
|
|
later. It also works for LaTeX with the listings package, if you turn on the
|
|
option @code{org-export-latex-listings} and make sure that the listings
|
|
package is included by the LaTeX header.}. This is done with the @samp{src}
|
|
block, where you also need to specify the name of the major mode that should
|
|
be used to fontify the example:
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
|
|
(defun org-xor (a b)
|
|
"Exclusive or."
|
|
(if a (not b) b))
|
|
#+END_SRC
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
|
|
switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
|
|
numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
|
|
numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
|
|
Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
|
|
targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference name
|
|
enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
|
|
link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
|
|
cool.
|
|
|
|
You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
|
|
source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
|
|
labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
|
|
be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
|
|
switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
|
|
the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
|
|
Here is an example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
|
|
(save-excursion (ref:sc)
|
|
(goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
|
|
#+END_SRC
|
|
In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
|
|
jumps to point-min.
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-coderef-label-format
|
|
If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
|
|
@code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
|
|
-n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
|
|
|
|
HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @xref{Text
|
|
areas in HTML export}.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c '
|
|
@item C-c '
|
|
Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
|
|
switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
|
|
pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
|
|
or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
|
|
by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
|
|
for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}, the edited version will
|
|
then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
|
|
(where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
|
|
using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
|
|
variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
|
|
drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
|
|
fixed-width region.
|
|
@kindex C-c l
|
|
@item C-c l
|
|
Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
|
|
temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label, make sure
|
|
that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
|
|
formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
|
|
label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
|
|
@section Include files
|
|
@cindex include files, markup rules
|
|
|
|
During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
|
|
include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
|
|
@cindex #+INCLUDE
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g. @samp{quote},
|
|
@samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
|
|
language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional, if it is not
|
|
given, the text will be assumed to be in Org-mode format and will be
|
|
processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
|
|
parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
|
|
first line and for each following line, as well as any options accepted by
|
|
the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item, use
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c '
|
|
@item C-c '
|
|
Visit the include file at point.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
|
|
@section Index entries
|
|
@cindex index entries, for publishing
|
|
|
|
You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
|
|
publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
|
|
the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
|
|
an index} for more information.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* Curriculum Vitae
|
|
#+INDEX: CV
|
|
#+INDEX: Application!CV
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Index entries, Markup
|
|
@section Macro replacement
|
|
@cindex macro replacement, during export
|
|
@cindex #+MACRO
|
|
|
|
You can define text snippets with
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
|
|
code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
|
|
defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
|
|
will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
|
|
similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
|
|
@code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
|
|
and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
|
|
@var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
|
|
@code{format-time-string}.
|
|
|
|
Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
|
|
construct complex HTML code.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
|
|
@section Embedded La@TeX{}
|
|
@cindex @TeX{} interpretation
|
|
@cindex La@TeX{} interpretation
|
|
|
|
Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. One
|
|
exception, however, are scientific notes which need to be able to contain
|
|
mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. La@TeX{}@footnote{La@TeX{}
|
|
is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the
|
|
features described here as ``La@TeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for
|
|
simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} is widely used to typeset
|
|
scientific documents. Org-mode supports embedding La@TeX{} code into its
|
|
files, because many academics are used to reading La@TeX{} source code, and
|
|
because it can be readily processed into images for HTML production.
|
|
|
|
It is not necessary to mark La@TeX{} macros and code in any special way.
|
|
If you observe a few conventions, Org-mode knows how to find it and what
|
|
to do with it.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
|
|
* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
|
|
* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
|
|
* Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
|
|
* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
|
|
@subsection Special symbols
|
|
@cindex math symbols
|
|
@cindex special symbols
|
|
@cindex @TeX{} macros
|
|
@cindex La@TeX{} fragments, markup rules
|
|
@cindex HTML entities
|
|
@cindex La@TeX{} entities
|
|
|
|
You can use La@TeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
|
|
indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
|
|
for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
|
|
and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike La@TeX{}
|
|
code, Org-mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
|
|
delimiters, for example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-entities
|
|
During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
|
|
the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
|
|
@code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the La@TeX{}
|
|
output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
|
|
@code{~} in La@TeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
|
|
like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
|
|
|
|
A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
|
|
La@TeX{}, see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
|
|
@samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
|
|
@samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
|
|
different lengths or a compact set of dots.
|
|
|
|
If you would like to see entities displayed as utf8 characters, use the
|
|
following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
|
|
variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
|
|
@code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x \
|
|
@item C-c C-x \
|
|
Toggle display of entities as UTF8 characters. This does not change the
|
|
buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF8 character
|
|
for display purposes only.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
|
|
@subsection Subscripts and superscripts
|
|
@cindex subscript
|
|
@cindex superscript
|
|
|
|
Just like in La@TeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
|
|
and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
|
|
math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
|
|
not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
|
|
with curly braces. For example
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
The mass if the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
|
|
the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
|
|
To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
|
|
@samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
|
|
where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
|
|
to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
|
|
variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
|
|
convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+OPTIONS: ^:@{@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x \
|
|
@item C-c C-x \
|
|
In addition to showing entities as UTF8 characters, this command will also
|
|
format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
|
|
@subsection La@TeX{} fragments
|
|
@cindex La@TeX{} fragments
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-format-latex-header
|
|
With symbols, sub- and superscripts, HTML is pretty much at its end when
|
|
it comes to representing mathematical formulas@footnote{Yes, there is
|
|
MathML, but that is not yet fully supported by many browsers, and there
|
|
is no decent converter for turning La@TeX{} or ASCII representations of
|
|
formulas into MathML. So for the time being, converting formulas into
|
|
images seems the way to go.}. More complex expressions need a dedicated
|
|
formula processor. To this end, Org-mode can contain arbitrary La@TeX{}
|
|
fragments. It provides commands to preview the typeset result of these
|
|
fragments, and upon export to HTML, all fragments will be converted to
|
|
images and inlined into the HTML document@footnote{The La@TeX{} export
|
|
will not use images for displaying La@TeX{} fragments but include these
|
|
fragments directly into the La@TeX{} code.}. For this to work you
|
|
need to be on a system with a working La@TeX{} installation. You also
|
|
need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
|
|
@url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The La@TeX{} header that
|
|
will be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the
|
|
variable @code{org-format-latex-header}.
|
|
|
|
La@TeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
|
|
snippets will be identified as La@TeX{} source code:
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
Environments of any kind. The only requirement is that the
|
|
@code{\begin} statement appears on a new line, preceded by only
|
|
whitespace.
|
|
@item
|
|
Text within the usual La@TeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
|
|
currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
|
|
math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
|
|
directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
|
|
and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
|
|
For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
|
|
@samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@noindent For example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
\begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
|
|
x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
|
|
\end@{equation@} % etc
|
|
|
|
If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
|
|
either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex org-format-latex-options
|
|
If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
|
|
can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
|
|
ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the La@TeX{} converter.
|
|
|
|
@node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
|
|
@subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
|
|
@cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
|
|
|
|
La@TeX{} fragments can be processed to produce preview images of the
|
|
typeset expressions:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-l
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-l
|
|
Produce a preview image of the La@TeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
|
|
over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
|
|
fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
|
|
with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
|
|
two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
|
|
process the entire buffer.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item C-c C-c
|
|
Remove the overlay preview images.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-format-latex-options
|
|
You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
|
|
some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
|
|
export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
|
|
preview images.
|
|
|
|
During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), all La@TeX{} fragments are
|
|
converted into images and inlined into the document if the following
|
|
setting is active:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments t)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
|
|
@subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
|
|
@cindex CDLa@TeX{}
|
|
|
|
CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
|
|
major La@TeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
|
|
environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of
|
|
some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
|
|
@file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
|
|
AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
|
|
Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light
|
|
version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it
|
|
on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
|
|
Org files with
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
|
|
details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@kindex C-c @{
|
|
@item
|
|
Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@kindex @key{TAB}
|
|
The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
|
|
La@TeX{} fragment@footnote{Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is
|
|
inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
|
|
@code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
|
|
expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
|
|
correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
|
|
the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
|
|
environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
|
|
you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
|
|
this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
|
|
To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@kindex _
|
|
@kindex ^
|
|
@vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
|
|
Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a La@TeX{} fragment will insert these
|
|
characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
|
|
out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
|
|
macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
|
|
@code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
|
|
@item
|
|
@kindex `
|
|
Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
|
|
macros, also outside La@TeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
|
|
after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
|
|
@item
|
|
@kindex '
|
|
Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
|
|
the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
|
|
1.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up. Character
|
|
modification will work only inside La@TeX{} fragments, outside the quote
|
|
is normal.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
|
|
@chapter Exporting
|
|
@cindex exporting
|
|
|
|
Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
|
|
printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
|
|
version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
|
|
the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
|
|
broad range of other applications. La@TeX{} export lets you use Org-mode and
|
|
its structured editing functions to easily create La@TeX{} files. DocBook
|
|
export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
|
|
DocBook tools. For project management you can create gantt and resource
|
|
charts by using TaskJuggler export. To incorporate entries with associated
|
|
times like deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like
|
|
iCal, Org-mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
|
|
Org-mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
|
|
|
|
Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
|
|
enabled (default in Emacs 23).
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
|
|
* Export options:: Per-file export settings
|
|
* The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
|
|
* ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
|
|
* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
|
|
* LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
|
|
* DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
|
|
* TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
|
|
* Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
|
|
* XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
|
|
* iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
|
|
@section Selective export
|
|
@cindex export, selective by tags
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-select-tags
|
|
@vindex org-export-exclude-tags
|
|
You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
|
|
or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
|
|
@code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
|
|
|
|
Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
|
|
If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
|
|
selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
|
|
selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
|
|
export.
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
|
|
be removed from the export buffer.
|
|
|
|
@node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
|
|
@section Export options
|
|
@cindex options, for export
|
|
|
|
@cindex completion, of option keywords
|
|
The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
|
|
additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
|
|
The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
|
|
C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
|
|
correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
|
|
(@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
|
|
specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
|
|
In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
|
|
a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e t
|
|
@item C-c C-e t
|
|
Insert template with export options, see example below.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+TITLE
|
|
@cindex #+AUTHOR
|
|
@cindex #+DATE
|
|
@cindex #+EMAIL
|
|
@cindex #+DESCRIPTION
|
|
@cindex #+KEYWORDS
|
|
@cindex #+LANGUAGE
|
|
@cindex #+TEXT
|
|
@cindex #+OPTIONS
|
|
@cindex #+BIND
|
|
@cindex #+LINK_UP
|
|
@cindex #+LINK_HOME
|
|
@cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
|
|
@cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
|
|
@cindex #+XSLT
|
|
@cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
|
|
@vindex user-full-name
|
|
@vindex user-mail-address
|
|
@vindex org-export-default-language
|
|
@example
|
|
#+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
|
|
#+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
|
|
#+DATE: a date, fixed, of a format string for @code{format-time-string}
|
|
#+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
|
|
#+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
|
|
#+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
|
|
#+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
|
|
#+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
|
|
#+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
|
|
#+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
|
|
#+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
|
|
@r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
|
|
#+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
|
|
#+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
|
|
#+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
|
|
#+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
|
|
#+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
|
|
#+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
|
|
this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export settings. Here
|
|
you can:
|
|
@cindex headline levels
|
|
@cindex section-numbers
|
|
@cindex table of contents
|
|
@cindex line-break preservation
|
|
@cindex quoted HTML tags
|
|
@cindex fixed-width sections
|
|
@cindex tables
|
|
@cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
|
|
@cindex footnotes
|
|
@cindex special strings
|
|
@cindex emphasized text
|
|
@cindex @TeX{} macros
|
|
@cindex La@TeX{} fragments
|
|
@cindex author info, in export
|
|
@cindex time info, in export
|
|
@example
|
|
H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
|
|
num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
|
|
toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
|
|
\n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
|
|
@@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
|
|
:: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
|
|
|: @r{turn on/off tables}
|
|
^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
|
|
@r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
|
|
@r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
|
|
-: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
|
|
f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
|
|
todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
|
|
pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
|
|
tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
|
|
<: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
|
|
*: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
|
|
TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
|
|
LaTeX: @r{turn on/off La@TeX{} fragments}
|
|
skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
|
|
author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
|
|
email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
|
|
creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
|
|
timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
|
|
d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent
|
|
These options take effect in both the HTML and La@TeX{} export, except
|
|
for @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and
|
|
@code{nil} for the La@TeX{} export.
|
|
|
|
When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
|
|
calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
|
|
settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
|
|
@code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
|
|
@code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
|
|
|
|
@node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
|
|
@section The export dispatcher
|
|
@cindex dispatcher, for export commands
|
|
|
|
All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
|
|
prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
|
|
Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
|
|
contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
|
|
the subtrees are exported.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e
|
|
@item C-c C-e
|
|
@vindex org-export-run-in-background
|
|
Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
|
|
listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
|
|
command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
|
|
@kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
|
|
separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
|
|
the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v
|
|
@item C-c C-e v
|
|
Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
|
|
(i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
|
|
@kindex C-u C-u C-c C-e
|
|
@item C-u C-u C-c C-e
|
|
@vindex org-export-run-in-background
|
|
Call an the exporter, but reverse the setting of
|
|
@code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
|
|
not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
|
|
@section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
|
|
@cindex ASCII export
|
|
@cindex Latin-1 export
|
|
@cindex UTF-8 export
|
|
|
|
ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
|
|
file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
|
|
with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
|
|
|
|
@cindex region, active
|
|
@cindex active region
|
|
@cindex transient-mark-mode
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e a
|
|
@item C-c C-e a
|
|
@cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
|
|
Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
|
|
will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
|
|
warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
|
|
@code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
|
|
exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
|
|
current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
|
|
become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
|
|
@code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
|
|
export.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e A
|
|
@item C-c C-e A
|
|
Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e n
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e N
|
|
@item C-c C-e n @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e N
|
|
Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e u
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e U
|
|
@item C-c C-e u @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e U
|
|
Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v a
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v n
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v u
|
|
@item C-c C-e v a @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e v n @ @ @r{and} @ @ C-c C-e v u
|
|
Export only the visible part of the document.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@cindex headline levels, for exporting
|
|
In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
|
|
headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
|
|
will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
|
|
at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
|
|
headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
|
|
the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
|
|
the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
|
|
the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
|
|
the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
|
|
indentation than the first, these are left alone.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
|
|
Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
|
|
the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
|
|
@code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
|
|
|
|
@node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
|
|
@section HTML export
|
|
@cindex HTML export
|
|
|
|
Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
|
|
HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
|
|
language, but with additional support for tables.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
|
|
* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
|
|
* Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
|
|
* Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
|
|
* Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
|
|
* Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
|
|
* CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
|
|
* JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
|
|
@subsection HTML export commands
|
|
|
|
@cindex region, active
|
|
@cindex active region
|
|
@cindex transient-mark-mode
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e h
|
|
@item C-c C-e h
|
|
@cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
|
|
Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
|
|
the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
|
|
without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
|
|
@code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
|
|
exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
|
|
current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
|
|
title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
|
|
property, that name will be used for the export.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e b
|
|
@item C-c C-e b
|
|
Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e H
|
|
@item C-c C-e H
|
|
Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e R
|
|
@item C-c C-e R
|
|
Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
|
|
not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
|
|
the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v h
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v b
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v H
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v R
|
|
@item C-c C-e v h
|
|
@item C-c C-e v b
|
|
@item C-c C-e v H
|
|
@item C-c C-e v R
|
|
Export only the visible part of the document.
|
|
@item M-x org-export-region-as-html
|
|
Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
|
|
syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
|
|
buffer.
|
|
@item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
|
|
Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
|
|
code.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@cindex headline levels, for exporting
|
|
In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
|
|
defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
|
|
itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
|
|
specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
|
|
|
|
@node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML Export commands, HTML export
|
|
@subsection Quoting HTML tags
|
|
|
|
Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
|
|
@samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
|
|
which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
|
|
@samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
|
|
simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
|
|
the exported file use either
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+HTML
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
|
|
@example
|
|
#+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent or
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_HTML
|
|
All lines between these markers are exported literally
|
|
#+END_HTML
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
|
|
@subsection Links in HTML export
|
|
|
|
@cindex links, in HTML export
|
|
@cindex internal links, in HTML export
|
|
@cindex external links, in HTML export
|
|
Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
|
|
includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
|
|
targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
|
|
the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
|
|
@file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
|
|
that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
|
|
path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
|
|
files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
|
|
publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
|
|
|
|
If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
|
|
@code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
|
|
@code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
|
|
and @code{style} attributes for a link:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+ATTR_HTML
|
|
@example
|
|
#+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
|
|
[[http://orgmode.org]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
|
|
@subsection Tables
|
|
@cindex tables, in HTML
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-table-tag
|
|
|
|
Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
|
|
@code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
|
|
cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
|
|
tables, place something like the following before the table:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+CAPTION
|
|
@cindex #+ATTR_HTML
|
|
@example
|
|
#+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
|
|
#+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Images in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
|
|
@subsection Images in HTML export
|
|
|
|
@cindex images, inline in HTML
|
|
@cindex inlining images in HTML
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-inline-images
|
|
HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
|
|
it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
|
|
default@footnote{But see the variable
|
|
@code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
|
|
not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
|
|
while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
|
|
@samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
|
|
itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
|
|
image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
|
|
image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
|
|
will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
[[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
|
|
In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
|
|
support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+CAPTION
|
|
@cindex #+ATTR_HTML
|
|
@example
|
|
#+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
|
|
#+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
|
|
[[./img/a.jpg]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
|
|
|
|
@node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Images in HTML export, HTML export
|
|
@subsection Text areas in HTML export
|
|
|
|
@cindex text areas, in HTML
|
|
An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
|
|
areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
|
|
application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
|
|
@code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
|
|
label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
|
|
use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
|
|
text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
|
|
respectively. For example
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
|
|
(defun org-xor (a b)
|
|
"Exclusive or."
|
|
(if a (not b) b))
|
|
#+END_EXAMPLE
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
|
|
@subsection CSS support
|
|
@cindex CSS, for HTML export
|
|
@cindex HTML export, CSS
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
|
|
You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
|
|
assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
|
|
keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
|
|
@code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
|
|
@code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
|
|
parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
|
|
addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
|
|
@example
|
|
p.author @r{author information, including email}
|
|
p.date @r{publishing date}
|
|
p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
|
|
.title @r{document title}
|
|
.todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
|
|
.done @r{the DONE keywords, all stated the count as done}
|
|
.WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
|
|
.timestamp @r{timestamp}
|
|
.timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
|
|
.timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
|
|
.tag @r{tag in a headline}
|
|
._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
|
|
.target @r{target for links}
|
|
.linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
|
|
.code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
|
|
div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
|
|
div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
|
|
.section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
|
|
div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
|
|
pre.src @r{formatted source code}
|
|
pre.example @r{normal example}
|
|
p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
|
|
div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
|
|
p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
|
|
.footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
|
|
.footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-style-default
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-style
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-extra
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-style-default
|
|
Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
|
|
classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
|
|
@code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
|
|
inclusion of these defaults off, customize
|
|
@code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
|
|
settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
|
|
(for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
|
|
granular settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
|
|
individually for each file, you can use
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+STYLE
|
|
@example
|
|
#+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
|
|
directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
|
|
referring to an external file.
|
|
|
|
@c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
|
|
@c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
|
|
|
|
@node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
|
|
@subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
|
|
|
|
@cindex Rose, Sebastian
|
|
Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
|
|
enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
|
|
program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
|
|
is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
|
|
navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
|
|
as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
|
|
view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
|
|
script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
|
|
the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
|
|
We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
|
|
not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
|
|
copy on your own web server.
|
|
|
|
To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
|
|
gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
|
|
customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
|
|
this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
|
|
adding a single line to the Org file:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
|
|
@example
|
|
#+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
|
|
needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
|
|
viewing options:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
|
|
@r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
|
|
@r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
|
|
view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
|
|
info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
|
|
overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
|
|
content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
|
|
showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
|
|
sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
|
|
@r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
|
|
@r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
|
|
@r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
|
|
@r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
|
|
toc: @r{Should the table of content @emph{initially} be visible?}
|
|
@r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
|
|
tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
|
|
@r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
|
|
ftoc: @r{Does the css of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
|
|
@r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
|
|
ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
|
|
@r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
|
|
mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
|
|
@r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
|
|
buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
|
|
@r{default), only one such button will be present.}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex org-infojs-options
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
|
|
You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
|
|
@code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
|
|
pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
|
|
|
|
@node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
|
|
@section La@TeX{} and PDF export
|
|
@cindex La@TeX{} export
|
|
@cindex PDF export
|
|
@cindex Guerry, Bastien
|
|
|
|
Org-mode contains a La@TeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
|
|
further processing@footnote{The default LaTeX output is designed for
|
|
processing with pdftex or latex. It includes packages that are not
|
|
compatible with xetex and possibly luatex. See the variables
|
|
@code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
|
|
@code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
|
|
produce PDF output. Since the La@TeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
|
|
implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
|
|
linked.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
|
|
* Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
|
|
* Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
|
|
* Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
|
|
* Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
|
|
* Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
|
|
@subsection La@TeX{} export commands
|
|
|
|
@cindex region, active
|
|
@cindex active region
|
|
@cindex transient-mark-mode
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e l
|
|
@item C-c C-e l
|
|
@cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
|
|
Export as La@TeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an Org file
|
|
@file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
|
|
be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
|
|
requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
|
|
exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
|
|
current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
|
|
title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
|
|
property, that name will be used for the export.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e L
|
|
@item C-c C-e L
|
|
Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v l
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v L
|
|
@item C-c C-e v l
|
|
@item C-c C-e v L
|
|
Export only the visible part of the document.
|
|
@item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
|
|
Convert the region to La@TeX{} under the assumption that it was Org-mode
|
|
syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
|
|
buffer.
|
|
@item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
|
|
Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by La@TeX{}
|
|
code.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e p
|
|
@item C-c C-e p
|
|
Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e d
|
|
@item C-c C-e d
|
|
Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@cindex headline levels, for exporting
|
|
@vindex org-latex-low-levels
|
|
In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
|
|
headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
|
|
will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
|
|
convert them to a custom string depending on
|
|
@code{org-latex-low-levels}.
|
|
|
|
If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
|
|
with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
|
|
|
|
@node Header and sectioning, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
|
|
@subsection Header and sectioning structure
|
|
@cindex La@TeX{} class
|
|
@cindex La@TeX{} sectioning structure
|
|
@cindex La@TeX{} header
|
|
@cindex header, for LaTeX files
|
|
@cindex sectioning structure, for LaTeX export
|
|
|
|
By default, the La@TeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-latex-default-class
|
|
@vindex org-export-latex-classes
|
|
@vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
|
|
@vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
|
|
@cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
|
|
@cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
|
|
@cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
|
|
@cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
|
|
@cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
|
|
You can change this globally by setting a different value for
|
|
@code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
|
|
@code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
|
|
property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
|
|
The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
|
|
defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
|
|
@code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
|
|
@code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
|
|
define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
|
|
classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
|
|
property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. You
|
|
can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the
|
|
header. See the docstring of @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more
|
|
information.
|
|
|
|
@node Quoting LaTeX code, Tables in LaTeX export, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export
|
|
@subsection Quoting La@TeX{} code
|
|
|
|
Embedded La@TeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
|
|
inserted into the La@TeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
|
|
@samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
|
|
you can add special code that should only be present in La@TeX{} export with
|
|
the following constructs:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+LaTeX
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
|
|
@example
|
|
#+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent or
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_LaTeX
|
|
All lines between these markers are exported literally
|
|
#+END_LaTeX
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
|
|
@subsection Tables in La@TeX{} export
|
|
@cindex tables, in La@TeX{} export
|
|
|
|
For La@TeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
|
|
(@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
|
|
request a @code{longtable} environment for the table, so that it may span
|
|
several pages, or provide the @code{multicolumn} keyword that will make the
|
|
table span the page in a multicolumn environment (@code{table*} environment).
|
|
Finally, you can set the alignment string:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+CAPTION
|
|
@cindex #+LABEL
|
|
@cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
|
|
@example
|
|
#+CAPTION: A long table
|
|
#+LABEL: tbl:long
|
|
#+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
|
|
| ..... | ..... |
|
|
| ..... | ..... |
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Images in LaTeX export, Beamer class export, Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
|
|
@subsection Images in La@TeX{} export
|
|
@cindex images, inline in La@TeX{}
|
|
@cindex inlining images in La@TeX{}
|
|
|
|
Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
|
|
@samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
|
|
output file resulting from La@TeX{} processing. Org will use an
|
|
@code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
|
|
caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
|
|
will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
|
|
element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the various
|
|
options that can be used in the optional argument of the
|
|
@code{\includegraphics} macro. To modify the placement option of the
|
|
@code{figure} environment, add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the
|
|
Attributes.
|
|
|
|
If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
|
|
to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
|
|
half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
|
|
of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
|
|
that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
|
|
for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+CAPTION
|
|
@cindex #+LABEL
|
|
@cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
|
|
@example
|
|
#+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
|
|
#+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
|
|
#+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
|
|
[[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
|
|
|
|
#+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
|
|
[[./img/hst.png]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you need references to a label created in this way, write
|
|
@samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in La@TeX{}.
|
|
|
|
@node Beamer class export, , Images in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
|
|
@subsection Beamer class export
|
|
|
|
The LaTeX class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
|
|
using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for turning an
|
|
Org-mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
|
|
|
|
When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
|
|
beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
|
|
@code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
|
|
presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
|
|
exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
|
|
the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
|
|
frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
|
|
You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
|
|
different level - then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
|
|
structure of the presentation.
|
|
|
|
A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
|
|
the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
|
|
things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
|
|
editing special properties used by beamer.
|
|
|
|
You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
|
|
properties:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item BEAMER_env
|
|
The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
|
|
are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
|
|
can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
|
|
set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
|
|
visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
|
|
@item BEAMER_envargs
|
|
The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
|
|
@code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
|
|
property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
|
|
set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
|
|
@code{c[t]} will set an option for the implied @code{column} environment.
|
|
@item BEAMER_col
|
|
The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
|
|
set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
|
|
Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
|
|
interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
|
|
that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
|
|
in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
|
|
This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
|
|
with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
|
|
@item BEAMER_extra
|
|
Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
|
|
opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
|
|
transitions.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
|
|
source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
|
|
specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
|
|
@code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
|
|
backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
|
|
in the presentation as well.
|
|
|
|
Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
|
|
@samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
|
|
into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
|
|
note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
|
|
generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
|
|
@code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
|
|
@code{BEAMER_env} property.
|
|
|
|
You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
|
|
support with
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+STARTUP: beamer
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-b
|
|
@item C-c C-b
|
|
In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
|
|
environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
|
|
important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
|
|
toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
|
|
org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
|
|
|
|
Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
|
|
|
|
@smallexample
|
|
#+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
|
|
#+TITLE: Example Presentation
|
|
#+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
|
|
#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
|
|
#+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
|
|
#+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
|
|
#+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
|
|
|
|
* This is the first structural section
|
|
|
|
** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
|
|
*** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:BEAMER_env: block
|
|
:BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
|
|
:BEAMER_col: 0.5
|
|
:END:
|
|
for the first viable beamer setup in Org
|
|
*** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:BEAMER_col: 0.5
|
|
:BEAMER_env: block
|
|
:BEAMER_envargs: <2->
|
|
:END:
|
|
for contributing to the discussion
|
|
**** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
|
|
** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
|
|
*** Request :B_block:
|
|
Please test this stuff!
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:BEAMER_env: block
|
|
:END:
|
|
@end smallexample
|
|
|
|
For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
|
|
|
|
@node DocBook export, TaskJuggler export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
|
|
@section DocBook export
|
|
@cindex DocBook export
|
|
@cindex PDF export
|
|
@cindex Cui, Baoqiu
|
|
|
|
Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
|
|
exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
|
|
formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
|
|
tools and stylesheets.
|
|
|
|
Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
|
|
* Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
|
|
* Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
|
|
* Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
|
|
* Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
|
|
* Special characters:: How to handle special characters
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
|
|
@subsection DocBook export commands
|
|
|
|
@cindex region, active
|
|
@cindex active region
|
|
@cindex transient-mark-mode
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e D
|
|
@item C-c C-e D
|
|
@cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
|
|
Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
|
|
file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
|
|
warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
|
|
@code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
|
|
exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
|
|
current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
|
|
title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
|
|
property, that name will be used for the export.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e V
|
|
@item C-c C-e V
|
|
Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
|
|
@vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
|
|
Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
|
|
need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
|
|
system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
|
|
@code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
|
|
The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
|
|
@code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
|
|
variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
|
|
the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
|
|
adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v D
|
|
@item C-c C-e v D
|
|
Export only the visible part of the document.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
|
|
@subsection Quoting DocBook code
|
|
|
|
You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
|
|
DocBook file with the following constructs:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+DOCBOOK
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
|
|
@example
|
|
#+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent or
|
|
@cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
|
|
All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
|
|
literally.
|
|
#+END_DOCBOOK
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
|
|
admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
|
|
document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
|
|
exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
|
|
<warning>
|
|
<para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
|
|
in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML file may be generated by
|
|
DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
|
|
</warning>
|
|
#+END_DOCBOOK
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
|
|
@subsection Recursive sections
|
|
@cindex DocBook recursive sections
|
|
|
|
DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
|
|
element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e. @code{section} elements, are
|
|
used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
|
|
top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
|
|
sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
|
|
matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
|
|
|
|
Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
|
|
code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
|
|
|
|
@node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
|
|
@subsection Tables in DocBook export
|
|
@cindex tables, in DocBook export
|
|
|
|
Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
|
|
DocBook V4.3.
|
|
|
|
If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
|
|
@code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
|
|
using the @code{table} element.
|
|
|
|
@node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
|
|
@subsection Images in DocBook export
|
|
@cindex images, inline in DocBook
|
|
@cindex inlining images in DocBook
|
|
|
|
Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
|
|
@samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
|
|
using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
|
|
an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
|
|
specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
|
|
@code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
|
|
also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
|
|
@code{mediaobject} element.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
|
|
Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
|
|
or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
|
|
variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
|
|
@code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
|
|
@code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
|
|
images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
|
|
attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
|
|
|
|
The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
|
|
attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
|
|
the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
|
|
variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
|
|
takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
|
|
set:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+CAPTION
|
|
@cindex #+LABEL
|
|
@cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
|
|
@example
|
|
#+CAPTION: The logo of Org-mode
|
|
#+LABEL: unicorn-svg
|
|
#+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
|
|
[[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
|
|
By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
|
|
@file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
|
|
customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
|
|
more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
|
|
|
|
@node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
|
|
@subsection Special characters in DocBook export
|
|
@cindex Special characters in DocBook export
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
|
|
@vindex org-entities
|
|
Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
|
|
@code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
|
|
characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
|
|
@code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
|
|
@code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
|
|
corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
|
|
|
|
You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
|
|
entities you need. For example, you can set variable
|
|
@code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
|
|
special characters included in XHTML entities:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
"<!DOCTYPE article [
|
|
<!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
|
|
\"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
|
|
\"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
|
|
>
|
|
%xhtml1-symbol;
|
|
]>
|
|
"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, DocBook export, Exporting
|
|
@section TaskJuggler export
|
|
@cindex TaskJuggler export
|
|
@cindex Project management
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
|
|
It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
|
|
resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
|
|
you have provided.
|
|
|
|
The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
|
|
HTML and LaTeX exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
|
|
nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
|
|
document.
|
|
|
|
Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
|
|
a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
|
|
creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
|
|
all the nodes.
|
|
|
|
@subsection TaskJuggler export commands
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e j
|
|
@item C-c C-e j
|
|
Export as TaskJuggler file.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e J
|
|
@item C-c C-e J
|
|
Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@subsection Tasks
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
|
|
Create your tasks as you usually do with Org-mode. Assign efforts to each
|
|
task using properties (it's easiest to do this in the column view). You
|
|
should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
|
|
@url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
|
|
Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
|
|
@code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
|
|
@code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
|
|
the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
|
|
open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
|
|
|
|
@subsection Resources
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
|
|
Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
|
|
can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
|
|
with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
|
|
@code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
|
|
identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
|
|
Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
|
|
generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
|
|
headline as the identifier as long as it is unique, see the documentation of
|
|
@code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
|
|
allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
|
|
property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
|
|
@kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
|
|
|
|
Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
|
|
in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
|
|
time.
|
|
|
|
@subsection Export of properties
|
|
|
|
The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e. if a
|
|
task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
|
|
TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
|
|
resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
|
|
@samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
|
|
@samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
|
|
@samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
|
|
@samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
|
|
@samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
|
|
|
|
@subsection Dependencies
|
|
|
|
The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
|
|
with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
|
|
@samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see org-depend.el) or alternatively with a
|
|
@samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
|
|
attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
|
|
identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
|
|
project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
|
|
dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
|
|
optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
|
|
examples should illustrate this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* Preparation
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:task_id: preparation
|
|
:ORDERED: t
|
|
:END:
|
|
* Training material
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:task_id: training_material
|
|
:ORDERED: t
|
|
:END:
|
|
** Markup Guidelines
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:Effort: 2.0
|
|
:END:
|
|
** Workflow Guidelines
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:Effort: 2.0
|
|
:END:
|
|
* Presentation
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:Effort: 2.0
|
|
:BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
|
|
:END:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@subsection Reports
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
|
|
TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g. gantt chart, resource
|
|
allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
|
|
for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
|
|
some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
|
|
@code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
|
|
customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
|
|
@kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
|
|
|
|
For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
|
|
@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.php}.
|
|
|
|
@node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
|
|
@section Freemind export
|
|
@cindex Freemind export
|
|
@cindex mind map
|
|
|
|
The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e m
|
|
@item C-c C-e m
|
|
Export as Freemind mind map @file{myfile.mm}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
|
|
@section XOXO export
|
|
@cindex XOXO export
|
|
|
|
Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
|
|
Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
|
|
does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e x
|
|
@item C-c C-e x
|
|
Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e v
|
|
@item C-c C-e v x
|
|
Export only the visible part of the document.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
|
|
@section iCalendar export
|
|
@cindex iCalendar export
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
|
|
@vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
|
|
@vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
|
|
@vindex org-icalendar-categories
|
|
@vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
|
|
Some people use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
|
|
standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
|
|
case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
|
|
files in the calendar application. Org-mode can export calendar information
|
|
in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
|
|
included in the export, configure the variable
|
|
@code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
|
|
and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
|
|
in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
|
|
to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
|
|
@code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
|
|
As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
|
|
file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
|
|
configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
|
|
@code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
|
|
time.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
|
|
@cindex property, ID
|
|
The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
|
|
identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
|
|
the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
|
|
@code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
|
|
entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
|
|
a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
|
|
prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
|
|
In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
|
|
figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e i
|
|
@item C-c C-e i
|
|
Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
|
|
directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e I
|
|
@item C-c C-e I
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-files
|
|
Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
|
|
@code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
|
|
file will be written.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e c
|
|
@item C-c C-e c
|
|
@vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
|
|
Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
|
|
@code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
|
|
@code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-use-property-inheritance
|
|
@vindex org-icalendar-include-body
|
|
@cindex property, SUMMARY
|
|
@cindex property, DESCRIPTION
|
|
@cindex property, LOCATION
|
|
The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
|
|
property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
|
|
@code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
|
|
entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
|
|
and the description from the body (limited to
|
|
@code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
|
|
|
|
How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
|
|
you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
|
|
|
|
@node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
|
|
@chapter Publishing
|
|
@cindex publishing
|
|
|
|
Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
|
|
automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
|
|
files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
|
|
pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
|
|
server.
|
|
|
|
You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
|
|
conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
|
|
|
|
Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Configuration:: Defining projects
|
|
* Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
|
|
* Sample configuration:: Example projects
|
|
* Triggering publication:: Publication commands
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
|
|
@section Configuration
|
|
|
|
Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
|
|
and many other properties of a project.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Project alist:: The central configuration variable
|
|
* Sources and destinations:: From here to there
|
|
* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
|
|
* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
|
|
* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
|
|
* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
|
|
* Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
|
|
* Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
|
|
@subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
|
|
@cindex org-publish-project-alist
|
|
@cindex projects, for publishing
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-publish-project-alist
|
|
Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
|
|
variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
|
|
configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
|
|
@r{or}
|
|
("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
|
|
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
|
|
project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
|
|
publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
|
|
takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
|
|
@code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
|
|
together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
|
|
a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
|
|
sequence given.
|
|
|
|
@node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
|
|
@subsection Sources and destinations for files
|
|
@cindex directories, for publishing
|
|
|
|
Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
|
|
particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
|
|
and where to put published files.
|
|
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
|
|
@item @code{:base-directory}
|
|
@tab Directory containing publishing source files
|
|
@item @code{:publishing-directory}
|
|
@tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
|
|
publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
|
|
the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
|
|
use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
|
|
@item @code{:preparation-function}
|
|
@tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
|
|
publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
|
|
published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
|
|
variable @code{project-plist}.
|
|
@item @code{:completion-function}
|
|
@tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
|
|
process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
|
|
project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
|
|
@code{project-plist}.
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
@noindent
|
|
|
|
@node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
|
|
@subsection Selecting files
|
|
@cindex files, selecting for publishing
|
|
|
|
By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
|
|
are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
|
|
properties
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
|
|
@item @code{:base-extension}
|
|
@tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
|
|
regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
|
|
files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{:exclude}
|
|
@tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
|
|
published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
|
|
extension.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{:include}
|
|
@tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
|
|
and @code{:exclude}.
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
|
|
@node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
|
|
@subsection Publishing action
|
|
@cindex action, for publishing
|
|
|
|
Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
|
|
possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
|
|
Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
|
|
@code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
|
|
export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
|
|
@code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}. If you want to publish the Org file itself,
|
|
but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use
|
|
@code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the parameters @code{:plain-source}
|
|
and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will produce @file{file.org} and
|
|
@file{file.org.html} in the publishing
|
|
directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
|
|
source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
|
|
setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
|
|
definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to avoid that the published
|
|
source files will be considered as new org files the next time the project is
|
|
published.}. Other files like images only
|
|
need to be copied to the publishing destination, for this you may use
|
|
@code{org-publish-attachment}. For non-Org files, you always need to
|
|
specify the publishing function:
|
|
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
|
|
@item @code{:publishing-function}
|
|
@tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
|
|
list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
|
|
@item @code{:plain-source}
|
|
@tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
|
|
@item @code{:htmlized-source}
|
|
@tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
|
|
The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
|
|
a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
|
|
published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
|
|
should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
|
|
and place the result into the destination folder.
|
|
|
|
@node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
|
|
@subsection Options for the HTML/La@TeX{} exporters
|
|
@cindex options, for publishing
|
|
|
|
The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
|
|
and La@TeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
|
|
variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
|
|
with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
|
|
respective variable for details.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-link-up
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-link-home
|
|
@vindex org-export-default-language
|
|
@vindex org-display-custom-times
|
|
@vindex org-export-headline-levels
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
|
|
@vindex org-export-section-number-format
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-toc
|
|
@vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-emphasize
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-special-strings
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-footnotes
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-drawers
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-tags
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-priority
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
|
|
@vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-timestamps
|
|
@vindex org-export-author-info
|
|
@vindex org-export-email
|
|
@vindex org-export-creator-info
|
|
@vindex org-export-with-tables
|
|
@vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-style
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-style-extra
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-inline-images
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-extension
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-table-tag
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-expand
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
|
|
@vindex org-export-publishing-directory
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-preamble
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-postamble
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-auto-preamble
|
|
@vindex org-export-html-auto-postamble
|
|
@vindex user-full-name
|
|
@vindex user-mail-address
|
|
@vindex org-export-select-tags
|
|
@vindex org-export-exclude-tags
|
|
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
|
|
@item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
|
|
@item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
|
|
@item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
|
|
@item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
|
|
@item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
|
|
@item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
|
|
@item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
|
|
@item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
|
|
@item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
|
|
@item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
|
|
@item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
|
|
@item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
|
|
@item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
|
|
@item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
|
|
@item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
|
|
@item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
|
|
@item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
|
|
@item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
|
|
@item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
|
|
@item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
|
|
@item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
|
|
@item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
|
|
@item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
|
|
@item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
|
|
@item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
|
|
@item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
|
|
@item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
|
|
@item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
|
|
@item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
|
|
@item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
|
|
@item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
|
|
@item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
|
|
@item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
|
|
@item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
|
|
@item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
|
|
@item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
|
|
@item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
|
|
@item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
|
|
@item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
|
|
@item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
|
|
@item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
|
|
@item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
|
|
@item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
|
|
@item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
|
|
@item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
|
|
@item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
|
|
@item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
|
|
@item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
|
|
@item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
|
|
Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
|
|
both HTML and La@TeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
|
|
@code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
|
|
La@TeX{} export.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-publish-project-alist
|
|
When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
|
|
its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
|
|
any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
|
|
options}), however, override everything.
|
|
|
|
@node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
|
|
@subsection Links between published files
|
|
@cindex links, publishing
|
|
|
|
To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
|
|
something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
|
|
@samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
|
|
becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
|
|
pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
|
|
you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
|
|
to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
|
|
because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
|
|
@file{html} file.
|
|
|
|
You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
|
|
with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
|
|
the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
|
|
an example of this usage.
|
|
|
|
Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
|
|
only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
|
|
location. In this case, use the property
|
|
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
|
|
@item @code{:link-validation-function}
|
|
@tab Function to validate links
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
|
|
accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
|
|
the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
|
|
function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
|
|
description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
|
|
function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
|
|
file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
|
|
|
|
@node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
|
|
@subsection Generating a sitemap
|
|
@cindex sitemap, of published pages
|
|
|
|
The following properties may be used to control publishing of
|
|
a map of files for a given project.
|
|
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
|
|
@item @code{:auto-sitemap}
|
|
@tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
|
|
or @code{org-publish-all}.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{:sitemap-filename}
|
|
@tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
|
|
becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
|
|
|
|
@item @code{:sitemap-title}
|
|
@tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{:sitemap-function}
|
|
@tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
|
|
Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
|
|
of links to all files in the project.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
|
|
@tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
|
|
(default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
|
|
respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{:sitemap-alphabetically}
|
|
@tab The site map is normally sorted alphabetically. Set this explicitly to
|
|
@code{nil} to turn off sorting.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
|
|
@tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
|
|
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
|
|
@node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
|
|
@subsection Generating an index
|
|
@cindex index, in a publishing project
|
|
|
|
Org-mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
|
|
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
|
|
@item @code{:makeindex}
|
|
@tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
|
|
publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
|
|
The file will be create when first publishing a project with the
|
|
@code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+include:
|
|
"theindex.inc"}. You can then built around this include statement by adding
|
|
a title, style information etc.
|
|
|
|
@node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
|
|
@section Uploading files
|
|
@cindex rsync
|
|
@cindex unison
|
|
|
|
For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
|
|
@command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
|
|
@i{remote} publishing facilities of Org-mode which rely heavily on
|
|
Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
|
|
so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
|
|
under heavy usage.
|
|
|
|
Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
|
|
to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
|
|
checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
|
|
directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
|
|
@file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
|
|
|
|
Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
|
|
a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
|
|
definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
|
|
files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
|
|
You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
|
|
@file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
|
|
tool syncs them.
|
|
|
|
Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
|
|
that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
|
|
@code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
|
|
benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
|
|
files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
|
|
Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
|
|
|
|
@node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
|
|
@section Sample configuration
|
|
|
|
Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
|
|
project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
|
|
more complex, with a multi-component project.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Simple example:: One-component publishing
|
|
* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
|
|
@subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
|
|
|
|
This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
|
|
directory on the local machine.
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-publish-project-alist
|
|
'(("org"
|
|
:base-directory "~/org/"
|
|
:publishing-directory "~/public_html"
|
|
:section-numbers nil
|
|
:table-of-contents nil
|
|
:style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
|
|
href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
|
|
type=\"text/css\"/>")))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
|
|
@subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
|
|
|
|
This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
|
|
Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
|
|
style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
|
|
excluded.
|
|
|
|
To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
|
|
your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
|
|
paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
|
|
publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
|
|
@c
|
|
@example
|
|
file:../images/myimage.png
|
|
@end example
|
|
@c
|
|
On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
|
|
same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
|
|
right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-publish-project-alist
|
|
'(("orgfiles"
|
|
:base-directory "~/org/"
|
|
:base-extension "org"
|
|
:publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
|
|
:publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
|
|
:exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
|
|
:headline-levels 3
|
|
:section-numbers nil
|
|
:table-of-contents nil
|
|
:style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
|
|
href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
|
|
:auto-preamble t
|
|
:auto-postamble nil)
|
|
|
|
("images"
|
|
:base-directory "~/images/"
|
|
:base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
|
|
:publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
|
|
:publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
|
|
|
|
("other"
|
|
:base-directory "~/other/"
|
|
:base-extension "css\\|el"
|
|
:publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
|
|
:publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
|
|
("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
|
|
@section Triggering publication
|
|
|
|
Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e C
|
|
@item C-c C-e C
|
|
Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e P
|
|
@item C-c C-e P
|
|
Publish the project containing the current file.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e F
|
|
@item C-c C-e F
|
|
Publish only the current file.
|
|
@kindex C-c C-e E
|
|
@item C-c C-e E
|
|
Publish every project.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
|
|
Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
|
|
normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
|
|
publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
|
|
above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
|
|
This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
|
|
@code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
|
|
|
|
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
|
|
@comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
|
|
|
|
@node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
|
|
@chapter Working with source code
|
|
@cindex Schulte, Eric
|
|
@cindex Davison, Dan
|
|
@cindex source code, working with
|
|
|
|
Source code can be included in Org-mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
|
|
e.g.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
|
|
(defun org-xor (a b)
|
|
"Exclusive or."
|
|
(if a (not b) b))
|
|
#+END_SRC
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Org-mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
|
|
including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
|
|
code blocks, tangling of code blocks, and exporting code blocks and their
|
|
results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
|
|
Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
|
|
|
|
The following sections describe Org-mode's code block handling facilities.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
|
|
* Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
|
|
* Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
|
|
* Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
|
|
* Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
|
|
* Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
|
|
* Languages:: List of supported code block languages
|
|
* Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
|
|
* Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
|
|
* Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
|
|
* Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
|
|
* Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
|
|
@comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
|
|
|
|
@node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Structure of code blocks
|
|
@cindex code block, structure
|
|
@cindex source code, block structure
|
|
|
|
The structure of code blocks is as follows:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+srcname: <name>
|
|
#+begin_src <language> <switches> <header arguments>
|
|
<body>
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item <name>
|
|
This name is associated with the code block. This is similar to the
|
|
@samp{#+tblname} lines that can be used to name tables in Org-mode files.
|
|
Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate the
|
|
block from other places in the file, other files, or from Org-mode table
|
|
formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}).
|
|
@item <language>
|
|
The language of the code in the block.
|
|
@item <switches>
|
|
Switches controlling exportation of the code block (see switches discussion in
|
|
@ref{Literal examples})
|
|
@item <header arguments>
|
|
Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
|
|
tangling of code blocks. See the @ref{Header arguments}
|
|
section. Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
|
|
basis using properties.
|
|
@item <body>
|
|
The source code.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
|
|
@comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
|
|
|
|
@node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Editing source code
|
|
@cindex code block, editing
|
|
@cindex source code, editing
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c '
|
|
Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
|
|
a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
|
|
block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
|
|
buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
|
|
|
|
The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
|
|
following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
|
|
buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
|
|
further configuration options.
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item org-src-lang-modes
|
|
If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
|
|
@code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
|
|
then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
|
|
can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
|
|
@item org-src-window-setup
|
|
Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
|
|
@item org-src-preserve-indentation
|
|
This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
|
|
python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
|
|
@item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
|
|
By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set
|
|
this variable to nil to switch without asking.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
|
|
@comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
|
|
|
|
@node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Exporting code blocks
|
|
@cindex code block, exporting
|
|
@cindex source code, exporting
|
|
|
|
It is possible to export the @emph{contents} of code blocks, the
|
|
@emph{results} of code block evaluation, @emph{neither}, or @emph{both}. For
|
|
most languages, the default exports the contents of code blocks. However, for
|
|
some languages (e.g. @code{ditaa}) the default exports the results of code
|
|
block evaluation. For information on exporting code block bodies, see
|
|
@ref{Literal examples}.
|
|
|
|
The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
|
|
behavior:
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Header arguments:
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item :exports code
|
|
The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
|
|
described in @ref{Literal examples}.
|
|
@item :exports results
|
|
The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
|
|
Org-mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
|
|
block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
|
|
placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
|
|
block will not be exported.
|
|
@item :exports both
|
|
Both the code block and its results will be exported.
|
|
@item :exports none
|
|
Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
|
|
Setting the the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
|
|
ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
|
|
can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org-mode files are
|
|
exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org-mode is used as the
|
|
markup language for a wiki.
|
|
|
|
@comment node-name, next, previous, up
|
|
@comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
|
|
@node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Extracting source code
|
|
@cindex source code, extracting
|
|
@cindex code block, extracting source code
|
|
|
|
Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
|
|
referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
|
|
community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
|
|
using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
|
|
``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Header arguments
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item :tangle no
|
|
The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
|
|
@item :tangle yes
|
|
Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
|
|
name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
|
|
for the block language.
|
|
@item :tangle filename
|
|
Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v t
|
|
@subsubheading Functions
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item org-babel-tangle @kbd{C-c C-v t}
|
|
Tangle the current file.
|
|
@item org-babel-tangle-file
|
|
Choose a file to tangle.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Hooks
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
|
|
This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
|
|
Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
|
|
of tangled code files.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Evaluating code blocks
|
|
@cindex code block, evaluating
|
|
@cindex source code, evaluating
|
|
|
|
Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
|
|
potential for that code to do harm. Org-mode provides a number of safeguards
|
|
to ensure that it only evaluates code with explicit confirmation from the
|
|
user. For information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see
|
|
@ref{Code evaluation security}.} and the results placed in the Org-mode
|
|
buffer. By default, evaluation is only turned on for @code{emacs-lisp} code
|
|
blocks, however support exists for evaluating blocks in many languages. See
|
|
@ref{Languages} for a list of supported languages. See @ref{Structure of
|
|
code blocks} for information on the syntax used to define a code block.
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
|
|
@kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
|
|
@code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
|
|
evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
|
|
@code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
|
|
its results into the Org-mode buffer.
|
|
|
|
It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
|
|
Org-mode buffer or an Org-mode table. @code{#+call} (or synonymously
|
|
@code{#+function} or @code{#+lob}) lines can be used to remotely execute code
|
|
blocks located in the current Org-mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel''
|
|
(see @ref{Library of Babel}). These lines use the following syntax.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+call: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
|
|
#+function: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
|
|
#+lob: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item <name>
|
|
The name of the code block to be evaluated.
|
|
@item <arguments>
|
|
Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block.
|
|
@item <header arguments>
|
|
Header arguments can be placed after the function invocation. See
|
|
@ref{Header arguments} for more information on header arguments.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Library of Babel
|
|
@cindex babel, library of
|
|
@cindex source code, library
|
|
@cindex code block, library
|
|
|
|
The ``Library of Babel'' is a library of code blocks
|
|
that can be called from any Org-mode file. The library is housed in an
|
|
Org-mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org-mode.
|
|
Org-mode users can deposit functions they believe to be generally
|
|
useful in the library.
|
|
|
|
Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called remotely as if
|
|
they were in the current Org-mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating code blocks}
|
|
for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v l
|
|
Code blocks located in any Org-mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
|
|
Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
|
|
l}.
|
|
|
|
@node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Languages
|
|
@cindex babel, languages
|
|
@cindex source code, languages
|
|
@cindex code block, languages
|
|
|
|
Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
|
|
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
|
|
@item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
|
|
@item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab C @tab C
|
|
@item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
|
|
@item css @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
|
|
@item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
|
|
@item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
|
|
@item LaTeX @tab latex @tab Matlab @tab matlab
|
|
@item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
|
|
@item Octave @tab octave @tab OZ @tab oz
|
|
@item Perl @tab perl @tab Python @tab python
|
|
@item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
|
|
@item Sass @tab sass @tab GNU Screen @tab screen
|
|
@item shell @tab sh @tab SQL @tab sql
|
|
@item Sqlite @tab sqlite
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
|
|
Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
|
|
available, it can be found at
|
|
@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
|
|
|
|
The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
|
|
evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
|
|
be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
|
|
to your emacs configuration.
|
|
|
|
@quotation
|
|
The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
|
|
@code{R} code blocks.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(org-babel-do-load-languages
|
|
'org-babel-load-languages
|
|
'((emacs-lisp . nil)
|
|
(R . t)))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
|
|
elisp file with @code{require}.
|
|
|
|
@quotation
|
|
The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
|
|
@end quotation
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(require 'ob-clojure)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Header arguments
|
|
@cindex code block, header arguments
|
|
@cindex source code, block header arguments
|
|
|
|
Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
|
|
section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
|
|
describes each header argument in detail.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
|
|
* Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
|
|
@subsection Using header arguments
|
|
|
|
The values of header arguments can be set in five different ways, each more
|
|
specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
|
|
@menu
|
|
* System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
|
|
* Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
|
|
* Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
|
|
* Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
|
|
* Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
|
|
@subsubheading System-wide header arguments
|
|
@vindex org-babel-default-header-args
|
|
System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
|
|
@code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
:session => "none"
|
|
:results => "replace"
|
|
:exports => "code"
|
|
:cache => "no"
|
|
:noweb => "no"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@c @example
|
|
@c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
|
|
@c Its value is
|
|
@c ((:session . "none")
|
|
@c (:results . "replace")
|
|
@c (:exports . "code")
|
|
@c (:cache . "no")
|
|
@c (:noweb . "no"))
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c Documentation:
|
|
@c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
|
|
@c @end example
|
|
|
|
For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
|
|
@code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
|
|
expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
|
|
blocks.
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-babel-default-header-args
|
|
(cons '(:noweb . "yes")
|
|
(assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
|
|
@subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
|
|
Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
|
|
language-specific documentation available online at
|
|
@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
|
|
|
|
@node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
|
|
@subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
|
|
Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified through the use of a special
|
|
line placed anywhere in an Org-mode file. The line consists of the
|
|
@code{#+BABEL:} keyword followed by a series of header arguments which may be
|
|
specified using the standard header argument syntax.
|
|
|
|
For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
|
|
@code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
|
|
that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
|
|
inserted into the buffer.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BABEL: :session *R* :results silent
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
|
|
@subsubheading Header arguments in Org-mode properties
|
|
|
|
Header arguments are also read from Org-mode properties (see @ref{Property
|
|
syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
|
|
of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+property: tangle yes
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
|
|
with inheritance, so the value of the @code{:cache} header argument will default
|
|
to @code{yes} in all code blocks in the subtree rooted at the following
|
|
heading:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
* outline header
|
|
:PROPERTIES:
|
|
:cache: yes
|
|
:END:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x p
|
|
@vindex org-babel-default-header-args
|
|
Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
|
|
@code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
|
|
@code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
|
|
in Org-mode documents.
|
|
|
|
@node Code block specific header arguments, , Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Using header arguments
|
|
@subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
|
|
|
|
The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
|
|
code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
|
|
arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+begin_src} line.
|
|
Properties set in this way override both the values of
|
|
@code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
|
|
properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
|
|
is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
|
|
inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
|
|
@code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
|
|
preserved on export to HTML or LaTeX.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+source: factorial
|
|
#+begin_src haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
|
|
fac 0 = 1
|
|
fac n = n * fac (n-1)
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or function call lines can be set as shown below:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+call: factorial(n=5) :exports results
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
|
|
@subsection Specific header arguments
|
|
The following header arguments are defined:
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
|
|
* results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
|
|
be collected and handled
|
|
* file:: Specify a path for file output
|
|
* dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
|
|
directory for code block execution
|
|
* exports:: Export code and/or results
|
|
* tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
|
|
* no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
|
|
expansion during tangling
|
|
* comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
|
|
code files
|
|
* session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
|
|
* noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
|
|
* cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
|
|
* hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
|
|
* colnames:: Handle column names in tables
|
|
* rownames:: Handle row names in tables
|
|
* shebang:: Make tangled files executable
|
|
* eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:var}
|
|
The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
|
|
The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
|
|
these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
|
|
syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. The
|
|
values passed to arguments can be literal values, values from org-mode tables
|
|
and literal example blocks, or the results of other code blocks.
|
|
|
|
These values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays---see the
|
|
``indexable variable values'' heading below.
|
|
|
|
The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
|
|
@code{:var} header argument.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
:var name=assign
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
where @code{assign} can take one of the following forms
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item literal value
|
|
either a string @code{"string"} or a number @code{9}.
|
|
@item reference
|
|
a table name:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+tblname: example-table
|
|
| 1 |
|
|
| 2 |
|
|
| 3 |
|
|
| 4 |
|
|
|
|
#+source: table-length
|
|
#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
|
|
(length table)
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results: table-length
|
|
: 4
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+srcname:}, followed by
|
|
parentheses:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
|
|
(* 2 length)
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results:
|
|
: 8
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
In addition, an argument can be passed to the code block referenced
|
|
by @code{:var}. The argument is passed within the parentheses following the
|
|
code block name:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+source: double
|
|
#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=8
|
|
(* 2 input)
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results: double
|
|
: 16
|
|
|
|
#+source: squared
|
|
#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
|
|
(* input input)
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results: squared
|
|
: 4
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
|
|
It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
|
|
using the @code{#+source:} line of a code block. As in the following
|
|
example arguments can be packed inside of parenthesis, separated by commas,
|
|
following the source name.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+source: double(input=0, x=2)
|
|
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
|
|
(* 2 (+ input x))
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Indexable variable values
|
|
It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
|
|
the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
|
|
the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
|
|
will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. The
|
|
following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
|
|
@code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+results: example-table
|
|
| 1 | a |
|
|
| 2 | b |
|
|
| 3 | c |
|
|
| 4 | d |
|
|
|
|
#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
|
|
data
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results:
|
|
: a
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
|
|
@code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
|
|
example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
|
|
to @code{data}.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+results: example-table
|
|
| 1 | a |
|
|
| 2 | b |
|
|
| 3 | c |
|
|
| 4 | d |
|
|
| 5 | 3 |
|
|
|
|
#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
|
|
data
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results:
|
|
| 2 | b |
|
|
| 3 | c |
|
|
| 4 | d |
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
|
|
interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
|
|
@code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
|
|
column is referenced.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+results: example-table
|
|
| 1 | a |
|
|
| 2 | b |
|
|
| 3 | c |
|
|
| 4 | d |
|
|
|
|
#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
|
|
data
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results:
|
|
| 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
|
|
Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
|
|
another by commas, as shown in the following example.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+source: 3D
|
|
#+begin_src emacs-lisp
|
|
'(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
|
|
((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
|
|
((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
|
|
data
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results:
|
|
| 11 | 14 | 17 |
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:results}
|
|
|
|
There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option of
|
|
each type may be supplied per code block.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
@b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
|
|
from the code block
|
|
@item
|
|
@b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
|
|
return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
|
|
Org-mode buffer
|
|
@item
|
|
@b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
|
|
block should be handled.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Collection
|
|
The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
|
|
should be collected from the code block.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{value}
|
|
This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
|
|
code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
|
|
mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., python, use of this result type
|
|
requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
|
|
code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
|
|
@item @code{output}
|
|
The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
|
|
execution of the code block. This header argument places the
|
|
evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Type
|
|
|
|
The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
|
|
the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
|
|
table or scalar depending on their value.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{table}, @code{vector}
|
|
The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode table. If a single value is
|
|
returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
|
|
E.g., @code{:results value table}.
|
|
@item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
|
|
The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
|
|
converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org-mode
|
|
buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
|
|
@item @code{file}
|
|
The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
|
|
into the Org-mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
|
|
@item @code{raw}, @code{org}
|
|
The results are interpreted as raw Org-mode code and are inserted directly
|
|
into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
|
|
such by Org-mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
|
|
@item @code{html}
|
|
Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{begin_html}
|
|
block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
|
|
@item @code{latex}
|
|
Results assumed to be LaTeX and are enclosed in a @code{begin_latex} block.
|
|
E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
|
|
@item @code{code}
|
|
Result are assumed to be parseable code and are enclosed in a code block.
|
|
E.g., @code{:results value code}.
|
|
@item @code{pp}
|
|
The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
|
|
block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, python, and ruby. E.g.,
|
|
@code{:results value pp}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Handling
|
|
The following results options indicate what happens with the
|
|
results once they are collected.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{silent}
|
|
The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
|
|
the Org-mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
|
|
@item @code{replace}
|
|
The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
|
|
will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
|
|
@code{:results output replace}.
|
|
@item @code{append}
|
|
If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
|
|
be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
|
|
inserted as with @code{replace}.
|
|
@item @code{prepend}
|
|
If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
|
|
be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
|
|
inserted as with @code{replace}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node file, dir, results, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:file}
|
|
|
|
The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify a path for file output.
|
|
An Org-mode style @code{file:} link is inserted into the buffer as the result
|
|
(see @ref{Link format}). Common examples are graphical output from R,
|
|
gnuplot, ditaa and LaTeX code blocks.
|
|
|
|
Note that for some languages, including R, gnuplot, LaTeX and ditaa,
|
|
graphical output is sent to the specified file without the file being
|
|
referenced explicitly in the code block. See the documentation for the
|
|
individual languages for details. In contrast, general purpose languages such
|
|
as python and ruby require that the code explicitly create output
|
|
corresponding to the path indicated by @code{:file}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node dir, exports, file, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
|
|
|
|
While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
|
|
output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
|
|
execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
|
|
buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
|
|
the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
|
|
then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
|
|
the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
|
|
|
|
When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
|
|
(e.g. @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
|
|
case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
|
|
|
|
In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called Work in your
|
|
home directory, you could use
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+begin_src R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
|
|
matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Remote execution
|
|
A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
|
|
which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+begin_src R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
|
|
plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Text results will be returned to the local Org-mode buffer as usual, and file
|
|
output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
|
|
relative to the remote directory. An Org-mode link to the remote file will be
|
|
created.
|
|
|
|
So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
|
|
and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
[[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
|
|
sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
|
|
tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
|
|
install tramp separately in order for the these features to work correctly.
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Further points
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
|
|
determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
|
|
currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
|
|
@item
|
|
@code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
|
|
@code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
|
|
to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
|
|
links inserted into the buffer will *not* be expanded against @code{default
|
|
directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
|
|
@code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
|
|
which the link does not point.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:exports}
|
|
|
|
The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
|
|
or LaTeX exports of the Org-mode file.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{code}
|
|
The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
|
|
@code{:exports code}.
|
|
@item @code{results}
|
|
The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
|
|
@code{:exports results}.
|
|
@item @code{both}
|
|
Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
|
|
@code{:exports both}.
|
|
@item @code{none}
|
|
Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node tangle, comments, exports, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:tangle}
|
|
|
|
The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
|
|
block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{yes}
|
|
The code block is exported to a source code file named after the
|
|
basename (name w/o extension) of the Org-mode file. E.g., @code{:tangle
|
|
yes}.
|
|
@item @code{no}
|
|
The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
|
|
E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
|
|
@item other
|
|
Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
|
|
as a file basename to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle
|
|
basename}.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node comments, no-expand, tangle, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:comments}
|
|
By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
|
|
of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
|
|
block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set to ``yes''
|
|
e.g. @code{:comments yes} to enable the insertion of comments around code
|
|
blocks during tangling. The inserted comments contain pointers back to the
|
|
original Org file from which the comment was tangled.
|
|
|
|
@node no-expand, session, comments, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
|
|
|
|
By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
|
|
during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
|
|
specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
|
|
references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
|
|
@code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
|
|
|
|
@node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:session}
|
|
|
|
The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
|
|
language where state is preserved.
|
|
|
|
By default, a session is not started.
|
|
|
|
A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
|
|
a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
|
|
interpreted language.
|
|
|
|
@node noweb, cache, session, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:noweb}
|
|
|
|
The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' style (see
|
|
@ref{Noweb reference syntax}) references in a code block. This header
|
|
argument can have one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{no}
|
|
The default. No ``noweb'' syntax specific action is taken on evaluating
|
|
code blocks, However, noweb references will still be expanded during
|
|
tangling.
|
|
@item @code{yes}
|
|
All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
|
|
expanded before the block is evaluated.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
|
|
Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
|
|
@code{<<reference>>}.
|
|
This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
|
|
@code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
|
|
each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
|
|
|
|
This code block:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
-- <<example>>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
|
|
expands to:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
-- this is the
|
|
-- multi-line body of example
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
|
|
be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
|
|
references.
|
|
|
|
@node cache, hlines, noweb, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:cache}
|
|
|
|
The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
|
|
the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
|
|
unchanged code blocks. This header argument can have one of two
|
|
values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{no}
|
|
The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
|
|
every time it is called.
|
|
@item @code{yes}
|
|
Every time the code block is run a sha1 hash of the code and arguments
|
|
passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
|
|
@code{#+results:} line and will be checked on subsequent
|
|
executions of the code block. If the code block has not
|
|
changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node hlines, colnames, cache, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:hlines}
|
|
|
|
Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
|
|
hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
|
|
values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{no}
|
|
Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
|
|
desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
|
|
variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
|
|
default value yields the following results.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+tblname: many-cols
|
|
| a | b | c |
|
|
|---+---+---|
|
|
| d | e | f |
|
|
|---+---+---|
|
|
| g | h | i |
|
|
|
|
#+source: echo-table
|
|
#+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols
|
|
return tab
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results: echo-table
|
|
| a | b | c |
|
|
| d | e | f |
|
|
| g | h | i |
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@item @code{yes}
|
|
Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+tblname: many-cols
|
|
| a | b | c |
|
|
|---+---+---|
|
|
| d | e | f |
|
|
|---+---+---|
|
|
| g | h | i |
|
|
|
|
#+source: echo-table
|
|
#+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
|
|
return tab
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results: echo-table
|
|
| a | b | c |
|
|
|---+---+---|
|
|
| d | e | f |
|
|
|---+---+---|
|
|
| g | h | i |
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:colnames}
|
|
|
|
The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
|
|
@code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{nil}
|
|
If an input table looks like it has column names
|
|
(because its second row is an hline), then the column
|
|
names will be removed from the table before
|
|
processing, then reapplied to the results.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+tblname: less-cols
|
|
| a |
|
|
|---|
|
|
| b |
|
|
| c |
|
|
|
|
#+srcname: echo-table-again
|
|
#+begin_src python :var tab=less-cols
|
|
return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results: echo-table-again
|
|
| a |
|
|
|----|
|
|
| b* |
|
|
| c* |
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@item @code{no}
|
|
No column name pre-processing takes place
|
|
|
|
@item @code{yes}
|
|
Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
|
|
does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e. the second row is not an
|
|
hline)
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:rownames}
|
|
|
|
The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
|
|
or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item @code{no}
|
|
No row name pre-processing will take place.
|
|
|
|
@item @code{yes}
|
|
The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
|
|
and is then reapplied to the results.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+tblname: with-rownames
|
|
| one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
|
|
| two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
|
|
|
|
#+srcname: echo-table-once-again
|
|
#+begin_src python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
|
|
return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+results: echo-table-once-again
|
|
| one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
|
|
| two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:shebang}
|
|
|
|
Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
|
|
(e.g. @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
|
|
first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
|
|
permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
|
|
|
|
@node eval, , shebang, Specific header arguments
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:eval}
|
|
The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
|
|
specific code blocks. @code{:eval} accepts two arguments ``never'' and
|
|
``query''. @code{:eval never} will ensure that a code block is never
|
|
evaluated, this can be useful for protecting against the evaluation of
|
|
dangerous code blocks. @code{:eval query} will require a query for every
|
|
execution of a code block regardless of the value of the
|
|
@code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable.
|
|
|
|
@node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Results of evaluation
|
|
@cindex code block, results of evaluation
|
|
@cindex source code, results of evaluation
|
|
|
|
The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
|
|
as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
|
|
used. The following table shows the possibilities:
|
|
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
|
|
@item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
|
|
@item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
|
|
@item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
|
|
Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
|
|
non-session is returned to Org-mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
|
|
vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
|
|
|
|
@subsection Non-session
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:results value}
|
|
This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
|
|
in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
|
|
function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
|
|
function. In particular, note that python does not automatically return a
|
|
value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
|
|
@samp{return} statement will usually be required in python.
|
|
|
|
This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
|
|
automatically wrapped in a function definition.
|
|
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:results output}
|
|
The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
|
|
contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
|
|
languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
|
|
future work.)
|
|
|
|
@subsection @code{:session}
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:results value}
|
|
The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
|
|
inferior process. The result returned is the result of the last evaluation
|
|
performed by the interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific
|
|
manner: the value of the variable @code{_} in python and ruby, and the value
|
|
of @code{.Last.value} in R).
|
|
|
|
@subsubsection @code{:results output}
|
|
The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
|
|
inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
|
|
(text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
|
|
necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
|
|
were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
|
|
process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+begin_src python :results output
|
|
print "hello"
|
|
2
|
|
print "bye"
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+resname:
|
|
: hello
|
|
: bye
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
In non-session mode, the '2' is not printed and does not appear.
|
|
@example
|
|
#+begin_src python :results output :session
|
|
print "hello"
|
|
2
|
|
print "bye"
|
|
#+end_src
|
|
|
|
#+resname:
|
|
: hello
|
|
: 2
|
|
: bye
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input '2'
|
|
and prints out its value, '2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
|
|
unnecessary here).
|
|
|
|
@node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Noweb reference syntax
|
|
@cindex code block, noweb reference
|
|
@cindex syntax, noweb
|
|
@cindex source code, noweb reference
|
|
|
|
The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
|
|
Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
|
|
familiar Noweb syntax:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
<<code-block-name>>
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
|
|
references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
|
|
argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
|
|
evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
|
|
expanded before evaluation.
|
|
|
|
Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
|
|
correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
|
|
@code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
|
|
syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
|
|
the default value.
|
|
|
|
@node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Key bindings and useful functions
|
|
@cindex code block, key bindings
|
|
|
|
Many common Org-mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
|
|
the context.
|
|
|
|
Within a code block, the following key bindings
|
|
are active:
|
|
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab org-babel-execute-src-block
|
|
@kindex C-c C-o
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab org-babel-open-src-block-result
|
|
@kindex C-up
|
|
@item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab org-babel-load-in-session
|
|
@kindex M-down
|
|
@item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab org-babel-pop-to-session
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
|
|
In an Org-mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
|
|
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v a
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v C-a
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v b
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v C-b
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v f
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v C-f
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v g
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @tab org-babel-goto-named-source-block
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v h
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @tab org-babel-describe-bindings
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v l
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v C-l
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v p
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v C-p
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v s
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v C-s
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v t
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v C-t
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v z
|
|
@kindex C-c C-v C-z
|
|
@item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
|
|
@c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
|
|
@c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
|
|
|
|
@c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
|
|
@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab org-babel-sha1-hash
|
|
@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab org-babel-execute-buffer
|
|
@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab org-babel-tangle-file
|
|
@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab org-babel-lob-ingest
|
|
@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab org-babel-expand-src-block
|
|
@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab org-babel-execute-subtree
|
|
@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab org-babel-tangle
|
|
@c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab org-babel-switch-to-session
|
|
@c @end multitable
|
|
|
|
@node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
|
|
@section Batch execution
|
|
@cindex code block, batch execution
|
|
@cindex source code, batch execution
|
|
|
|
It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
|
|
script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
|
|
|
|
Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#!/bin/sh
|
|
# -*- mode: shell-script -*-
|
|
#
|
|
# tangle a file with org-mode
|
|
#
|
|
DIR=`pwd`
|
|
FILES=""
|
|
|
|
# wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
|
|
for i in $@@; do
|
|
FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
|
|
done
|
|
|
|
emacsclient \
|
|
--eval "(progn
|
|
(add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
|
|
(add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
|
|
(require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
|
|
(mapc (lambda (file)
|
|
(find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
|
|
(org-babel-tangle)
|
|
(kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
|
|
@chapter Miscellaneous
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
|
|
* Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
|
|
* Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
|
|
* Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
|
|
* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
|
|
* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
|
|
* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
|
|
* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
|
|
* Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Completion, Speed keys, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
|
|
@section Completion
|
|
@cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
|
|
@cindex completion, of TODO keywords
|
|
@cindex completion, of dictionary words
|
|
@cindex completion, of option keywords
|
|
@cindex completion, of tags
|
|
@cindex completion, of property keys
|
|
@cindex completion, of link abbreviations
|
|
@cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
|
|
@cindex TODO keywords completion
|
|
@cindex dictionary word completion
|
|
@cindex option keyword completion
|
|
@cindex tag completion
|
|
@cindex link abbreviations, completion of
|
|
|
|
Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
|
|
makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
|
|
some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
|
|
most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
|
|
@code{org-completion-use-ido}.
|
|
|
|
Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
|
|
not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
|
|
the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex M-@key{TAB}
|
|
@item M-@key{TAB}
|
|
Complete word at point
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
|
|
@item
|
|
After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
|
|
@item
|
|
After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
|
|
can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
|
|
@item
|
|
After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
|
|
from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
|
|
@samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
|
|
dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
|
|
@item
|
|
After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
|
|
of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
|
|
buffer.
|
|
@item
|
|
After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
|
|
@item
|
|
After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
|
|
@samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When the
|
|
option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
|
|
will insert example settings for this keyword.
|
|
@item
|
|
In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
|
|
i.e. valid keys for this line.
|
|
@item
|
|
Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Completion, Miscellaneous
|
|
@section Speed keys
|
|
@cindex speed keys
|
|
@vindex org-use-speed-commands
|
|
@vindex org-speed-commands-user
|
|
|
|
Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
|
|
beginning of a headline, i.e. before the first star. Configure the variable
|
|
@code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
|
|
pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
|
|
variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
|
|
navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
|
|
execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a tty,
|
|
or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
|
|
|
|
To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
|
|
with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
|
|
|
|
@node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
|
|
@section Code evaluation and security issues
|
|
|
|
Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
|
|
|
|
Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
|
|
written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
|
|
default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
|
|
permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
|
|
these precautions intact.
|
|
|
|
For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
|
|
become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
|
|
you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
|
|
|
|
Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
|
|
|
|
@table @i
|
|
@item Source code blocks
|
|
Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
|
|
C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
|
|
files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
|
|
files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
|
|
sources - just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
|
|
|
|
Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
|
|
which take off the default security brakes.
|
|
|
|
@defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
|
|
When set to t user is queried before code block evaluation
|
|
@end defopt
|
|
|
|
@item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
|
|
Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
|
|
links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
|
|
not visible.
|
|
|
|
@defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
|
|
Function to queries user about shell link execution.
|
|
@end defopt
|
|
@defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
|
|
Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
|
|
@end defopt
|
|
|
|
@item Formulas in tables
|
|
Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
|
|
either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
|
|
@section Customization
|
|
@cindex customization
|
|
@cindex options, for customization
|
|
@cindex variables, for customization
|
|
|
|
There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
|
|
Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
|
|
describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
|
|
variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
|
|
@code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
|
|
settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
|
|
lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
|
|
|
|
@node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
|
|
@section Summary of in-buffer settings
|
|
@cindex in-buffer settings
|
|
@cindex special keywords
|
|
|
|
Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
|
|
per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
|
|
keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
|
|
setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
|
|
lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
|
|
the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
|
|
buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
|
|
activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
|
|
when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-archive-location
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
|
|
This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
|
|
all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
|
|
of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
|
|
The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
|
|
@item #+CATEGORY:
|
|
This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
|
|
for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
|
|
end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
|
|
@item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
|
|
@cindex property, COLUMNS
|
|
Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
|
|
columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
|
|
applies.
|
|
@item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
|
|
@vindex org-table-formula-constants
|
|
@vindex org-table-formula
|
|
Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
|
|
line set the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
|
|
The global version of this variable is
|
|
@code{org-table-formula-constants}.
|
|
@item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
|
|
Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
|
|
top-level entries.
|
|
@item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
|
|
@vindex org-drawers
|
|
Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
|
|
@code{org-drawers}.
|
|
@item #+LINK: linkword replace
|
|
@vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
|
|
These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
|
|
@xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
|
|
@code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
|
|
@item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
|
|
@vindex org-highest-priority
|
|
@vindex org-lowest-priority
|
|
@vindex org-default-priority
|
|
This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
|
|
must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
|
|
have a lower ASCII number that the lowest priority.
|
|
@item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
|
|
This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
|
|
buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
|
|
@cindex #+SETUPFILE
|
|
@item #+SETUPFILE: file
|
|
This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
|
|
entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
|
|
(i.e. when starting Org-mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
|
|
settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
|
|
as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
|
|
any other Org-mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
|
|
cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
|
|
@item #+STARTUP:
|
|
@cindex #+STARTUP:
|
|
This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an
|
|
Org file is being visited.
|
|
|
|
The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
|
|
tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
|
|
@code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
|
|
@code{overview}.
|
|
@vindex org-startup-folded
|
|
@cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@example
|
|
overview @r{top-level headlines only}
|
|
content @r{all headlines}
|
|
showall @r{no folding of any entries}
|
|
showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-startup-indented
|
|
@cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
|
|
@code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
|
|
@example
|
|
indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
|
|
noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
|
|
Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
|
|
is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
|
|
variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
|
|
@code{nil}.
|
|
@cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@example
|
|
align @r{align all tables}
|
|
noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@vindex org-log-done
|
|
@vindex org-log-note-clock-out
|
|
@vindex org-log-repeat
|
|
Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
|
|
configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
|
|
@code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
|
|
@cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@example
|
|
logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
|
|
lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
|
|
nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
|
|
logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
|
|
lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
|
|
nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
|
|
lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
|
|
nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
|
|
logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
|
|
lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
|
|
nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
|
|
logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
|
|
lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
|
|
nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
|
|
logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
|
|
lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
|
|
nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@vindex org-hide-leading-stars
|
|
@vindex org-odd-levels-only
|
|
Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
|
|
indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
|
|
@code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
|
|
default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
|
|
@cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@example
|
|
hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
|
|
showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
|
|
indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
|
|
noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
|
|
odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
|
|
oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
|
|
@vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
|
|
To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
|
|
@code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
|
|
@code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
|
|
@cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@example
|
|
customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@vindex constants-unit-system
|
|
The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
|
|
@code{constants-unit-system}).
|
|
@cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@example
|
|
constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
|
|
constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@vindex org-footnote-define-inline
|
|
@vindex org-footnote-auto-label
|
|
@vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
|
|
To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
|
|
corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
|
|
@code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
|
|
@cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@example
|
|
fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
|
|
fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
|
|
fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
|
|
fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
|
|
fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
|
|
fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
|
|
fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
|
|
fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
|
|
nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@cindex org-hide-block-startup
|
|
To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
|
|
@code{org-hide-block-startup}.
|
|
@cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@example
|
|
hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
|
|
nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@cindex org-pretty-entities
|
|
The the display of entities as UTF8 characters is governed by the variable
|
|
@code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
|
|
@cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
|
|
@example
|
|
entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF8 characters where possible}
|
|
entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
|
|
@vindex org-tag-alist
|
|
These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
|
|
this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
|
|
keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
|
|
@item #+TBLFM:
|
|
This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
|
|
@item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
|
|
@itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
|
|
@itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
|
|
@itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
|
|
@itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
|
|
These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
|
|
@ref{Export options}.
|
|
@item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
|
|
@vindex org-todo-keywords
|
|
These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
|
|
current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
|
|
@section The very busy C-c C-c key
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@cindex C-c C-c, overview
|
|
|
|
The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
|
|
mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
|
|
this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
|
|
other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
|
|
here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
|
|
what this means in different contexts.
|
|
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item
|
|
If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
|
|
tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
|
|
triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
|
|
information.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
|
|
works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
|
|
the entire table.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
|
|
With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
|
|
default location.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
|
|
corresponding links in this buffer.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
|
|
drawer, offer property commands.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
|
|
definition, and vice versa.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
|
|
of the checkbox.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
|
|
ordered list.
|
|
@item
|
|
If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
|
|
block is updated.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
|
|
@section A cleaner outline view
|
|
@cindex hiding leading stars
|
|
@cindex dynamic indentation
|
|
@cindex odd-levels-only outlines
|
|
@cindex clean outline view
|
|
|
|
Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
|
|
potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
|
|
indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
|
|
where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
|
|
@emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@group
|
|
* Top level headline | * Top level headline
|
|
** Second level | * Second level
|
|
*** 3rd level | * 3rd level
|
|
some text | some text
|
|
*** 3rd level | * 3rd level
|
|
more text | more text
|
|
* Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
|
|
If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
|
|
with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
|
|
be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
|
|
this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
|
|
of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
|
|
property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
|
|
@code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
|
|
}. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
|
|
indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
|
|
@code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
|
|
stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
|
|
face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
|
|
@code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
|
|
@code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
|
|
works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
|
|
the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
|
|
individual files using
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+STARTUP: indent
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If you want a similar effect in earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
|
|
you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
|
|
file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
|
|
the following way:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
@emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
|
|
You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
|
|
with the headline, like
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
*** 3rd level
|
|
more text, now indented
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-adapt-indentation
|
|
Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
|
|
editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
|
|
preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-hide-leading-stars
|
|
@emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
|
|
all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
|
|
the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
|
|
with
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+STARTUP: hidestars
|
|
#+STARTUP: showstars
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
@group
|
|
* Top level headline
|
|
* Second level
|
|
* 3rd level
|
|
...
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
|
|
The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
|
|
fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
|
|
font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
|
|
have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
|
|
to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
|
|
example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-odd-levels-only
|
|
Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
|
|
levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
|
|
to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
|
|
or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
|
|
way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
|
|
to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
|
|
correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
|
|
a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+STARTUP: odd
|
|
#+STARTUP: oddeven
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
|
|
double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
|
|
RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
|
|
org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
@node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
|
|
@section Using Org on a tty
|
|
@cindex tty key bindings
|
|
|
|
Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
|
|
Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
|
|
accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
|
|
@key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
|
|
together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
|
|
these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
|
|
alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
|
|
more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
|
|
customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
|
|
is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
|
|
tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
|
|
|
|
@multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
|
|
@item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
|
|
@item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
|
|
@item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
|
|
@item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
|
|
@item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
|
|
@item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
|
|
@item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
|
|
@item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
|
|
@end multitable
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Interaction, , TTY keys, Miscellaneous
|
|
@section Interaction with other packages
|
|
@cindex packages, interaction with other
|
|
Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
|
|
with other code out there.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
|
|
* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
|
|
@subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
|
|
|
|
@table @asis
|
|
@cindex @file{calc.el}
|
|
@cindex Gillespie, Dave
|
|
@item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
|
|
Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
|
|
functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
|
|
checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
|
|
@code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
|
|
been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
|
|
distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
|
|
packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
|
|
, Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
|
|
@item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
|
|
@cindex @file{constants.el}
|
|
@cindex Dominik, Carsten
|
|
@vindex org-table-formula-constants
|
|
In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
|
|
names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
|
|
constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
|
|
the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
|
|
and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
|
|
@samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
|
|
at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
|
|
the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
|
|
setup. See the installation instructions in the file
|
|
@file{constants.el}.
|
|
@item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
|
|
@cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
|
|
@cindex Dominik, Carsten
|
|
Org-mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
|
|
La@TeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
|
|
@item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
|
|
@cindex @file{imenu.el}
|
|
Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org-mode
|
|
supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook
|
|
(lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
@vindex org-imenu-depth
|
|
By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
|
|
the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
|
|
@item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
|
|
@cindex @file{remember.el}
|
|
@cindex Wiegley, John
|
|
Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
|
|
@item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
|
|
@cindex @file{speedbar.el}
|
|
@cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
|
|
Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
|
|
index items in files. Org-mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
|
|
drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
|
|
restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
|
|
the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
|
|
@cindex @file{table.el}
|
|
@item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
|
|
@kindex C-c C-c
|
|
@cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
|
|
@cindex @file{table.el}
|
|
@cindex Ota, Takaaki
|
|
|
|
Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
|
|
and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
|
|
(@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
|
|
Org-mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
|
|
interference with other Org-mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
|
|
these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
|
|
@kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c '
|
|
@item C-c '
|
|
Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
|
|
@c
|
|
@kindex C-c ~
|
|
@item C-c ~
|
|
Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
|
|
command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
|
|
format. See the documentation string of the command
|
|
@code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
|
|
possible.
|
|
@end table
|
|
@file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
|
|
@item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
|
|
@cindex @file{footnote.el}
|
|
@cindex Baur, Steven L.
|
|
Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
|
|
However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
|
|
which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
|
|
@subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode
|
|
|
|
@table @asis
|
|
|
|
@cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
|
|
@vindex org-support-shift-select
|
|
In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
|
|
cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
|
|
This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
|
|
timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
|
|
at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
|
|
special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
|
|
@code{org-support-shift-select}. Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift
|
|
selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
|
|
commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
|
|
cursor moves across a special context.
|
|
|
|
@item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
|
|
@cindex @file{CUA.el}
|
|
@cindex Storm, Kim. F.
|
|
@vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
|
|
Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
|
|
(as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
|
|
region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
|
|
@code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
|
|
23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
|
|
if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
|
|
Org-mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
|
|
Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
|
|
buffer (but not during date selection).
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
|
|
S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
|
|
C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-disputed-keys
|
|
Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
|
|
to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
|
|
@code{org-disputed-keys}.
|
|
|
|
@item @file{yasnippet.el}
|
|
@cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
|
|
The way Org-mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
|
|
@code{"\t"}) overrules yasnippets' access to this key. The following code
|
|
fixed this problem:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(add-hook 'org-mode-hook
|
|
(lambda ()
|
|
(org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
|
|
(define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
|
|
@cindex @file{windmove.el}
|
|
This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
|
|
in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
|
|
the windmove function active in locations where Org-mode does not have
|
|
special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
|
|
configuration:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
|
|
(add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
|
|
(add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
|
|
(add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
|
|
(add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
|
|
@cindex @file{viper.el}
|
|
@kindex C-c /
|
|
Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
|
|
corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
|
|
another key for this command, or override the key in
|
|
@code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
|
|
@appendix Hacking
|
|
@cindex hacking
|
|
|
|
This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
|
|
Org.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
|
|
* Add-on packages:: Available extensions
|
|
* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
|
|
* Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
|
|
* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
|
|
* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
|
|
* Special agenda views:: Customized views
|
|
* Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
|
|
* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
|
|
* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
|
|
@section Hooks
|
|
@cindex hooks
|
|
|
|
Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
|
|
functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
|
|
use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
|
|
maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
|
|
@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
|
|
|
|
@node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
|
|
@section Add-on packages
|
|
@cindex add-on packages
|
|
|
|
A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
|
|
These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
|
|
packages with the separate release available at the Org-mode home page at
|
|
@uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
|
|
documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
|
|
@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
|
|
@section Adding hyperlink types
|
|
@cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
|
|
|
|
Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
|
|
(@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
|
|
provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
|
|
@file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
|
|
@samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
|
|
Emacs:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
|
|
|
|
(require 'org)
|
|
|
|
(org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
|
|
(add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
|
|
|
|
(defcustom org-man-command 'man
|
|
"The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
|
|
:group 'org-link
|
|
:type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
|
|
|
|
(defun org-man-open (path)
|
|
"Visit the manpage on PATH.
|
|
PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
|
|
(funcall org-man-command path))
|
|
|
|
(defun org-man-store-link ()
|
|
"Store a link to a manpage."
|
|
(when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
|
|
;; This is a man page, we do make this link
|
|
(let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
|
|
(link (concat "man:" page))
|
|
(description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
|
|
(org-store-link-props
|
|
:type "man"
|
|
:link link
|
|
:description description))))
|
|
|
|
(defun org-man-get-page-name ()
|
|
"Extract the page name from the buffer name."
|
|
;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
|
|
(if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
|
|
(match-string 1 (buffer-name))
|
|
(error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
|
|
|
|
(provide 'org-man)
|
|
|
|
;;; org-man.el ends here
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(require 'org-man)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Let's go through the file and see what it does.
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
|
|
loaded.
|
|
@item
|
|
The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
|
|
with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
|
|
that will be called to follow such a link.
|
|
@item
|
|
@vindex org-store-link-functions
|
|
The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
|
|
order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
|
|
buffer displaying a man page.
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
|
|
First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
|
|
command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
|
|
@code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
|
|
defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
|
|
path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
|
|
value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
|
|
|
|
Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
|
|
to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
|
|
try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
|
|
create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
|
|
of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
|
|
return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
|
|
manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
|
|
@samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
|
|
and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
|
|
can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
|
|
the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
|
|
buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
|
|
|
|
When is makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
|
|
@code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
|
|
support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
|
|
not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
|
|
|
|
@node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
|
|
@section Context-sensitive commands
|
|
@cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
|
|
@cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
|
|
@vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
|
|
|
|
Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
|
|
important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
|
|
Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
|
|
|
|
Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
|
|
special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
|
|
the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
|
|
allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
|
|
@footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the org-mode functionality
|
|
described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
|
|
package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
|
|
@code{#+RR:}.
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
|
|
"Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
|
|
(if (save-excursion
|
|
(beginning-of-line 1)
|
|
(looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
|
|
(progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
|
|
t) ;; to signal that we took action
|
|
nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
|
|
|
|
(add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
|
|
case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
|
|
signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
|
|
contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
|
|
@section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
|
|
@cindex tables, in other modes
|
|
@cindex lists, in other modes
|
|
@cindex Orgtbl mode
|
|
|
|
Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
|
|
frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
|
|
specific languages, for example La@TeX{}. However, this is extremely
|
|
hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
|
|
and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table
|
|
editor.
|
|
|
|
This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
|
|
table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
|
|
function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
|
|
@i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
|
|
the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
|
|
for a very flexible system.
|
|
|
|
Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
|
|
can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
|
|
@code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
|
|
(HTML, La@TeX{} or Texinfo.)
|
|
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
|
|
* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
|
|
* Translator functions:: Copy and modify
|
|
* Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
|
|
@subsection Radio tables
|
|
@cindex radio tables
|
|
|
|
To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
|
|
lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
|
|
Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
|
|
between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
/* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
|
|
/* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
|
|
Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
|
|
example:
|
|
@cindex #+ORGTBL
|
|
@example
|
|
#+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
|
|
in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
|
|
that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
|
|
arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
|
|
passed as a property list to the translation function for
|
|
interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
|
|
acted upon before the translation function is called:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item :skip N
|
|
Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
|
|
this parameter!
|
|
|
|
@item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
|
|
List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
|
|
calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
|
|
Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
|
|
removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
|
|
additional columns.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
|
|
without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
|
|
compilation of a C file or processing of a La@TeX{} file. There are a
|
|
number of different solutions:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
@item
|
|
The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
|
|
language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
|
|
@samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
|
|
@item
|
|
Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
|
|
statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
|
|
in La@TeX{}.
|
|
@item
|
|
You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
|
|
the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
|
|
only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
|
|
makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
|
|
key.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
@node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
|
|
@subsection A La@TeX{} example of radio tables
|
|
@cindex La@TeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
|
|
|
|
The best way to wrap the source table in La@TeX{} is to use the
|
|
@code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
|
|
activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
|
|
header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
|
|
default this works only for La@TeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
|
|
variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
|
|
modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
|
|
be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
|
|
will then get the following template:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
|
|
@example
|
|
% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
|
|
% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
|
|
\begin@{comment@}
|
|
#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
|
|
| | |
|
|
\end@{comment@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
@vindex La@TeX{}-verbatim-environments
|
|
The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
|
|
@code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into La@TeX{} and to put it
|
|
into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
|
|
fill in the table, feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
|
|
the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
|
|
this may cause problems with font-lock in La@TeX{} mode. As shown in the
|
|
example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
|
|
@code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
|
|
expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
|
|
much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
|
|
variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
|
|
% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
|
|
\begin@{comment@}
|
|
#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
|
|
| Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
|
|
|-------+------+---------+---------|
|
|
| Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
|
|
| Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
|
|
| March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
|
|
#+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
|
|
% $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
|
|
\end@{comment@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
|
|
table inserted between the two marker lines.
|
|
|
|
Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
|
|
want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
|
|
that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
|
|
table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
|
|
header and footer commands of the target table:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
\begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
|
|
Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
|
|
% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
|
|
% END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
|
|
\end@{tabular@}
|
|
%
|
|
\begin@{comment@}
|
|
#+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
|
|
| Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
|
|
|-------+------+---------+---------|
|
|
| Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
|
|
| Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
|
|
| March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
|
|
#+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
|
|
\end@{comment@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
The La@TeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
|
|
Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
|
|
and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
|
|
interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item :splice nil/t
|
|
When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
|
|
tabular environment. Default is nil.
|
|
|
|
@item :fmt fmt
|
|
A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
|
|
original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
|
|
you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
|
|
column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
|
|
A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
|
|
function must return a formatted string.
|
|
|
|
@item :efmt efmt
|
|
Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
|
|
have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
|
|
@code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
|
|
may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
|
|
@code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
|
|
@code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
|
|
applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
|
|
supplied instead of strings.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
|
|
@subsection Translator functions
|
|
@cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
|
|
@cindex translator function
|
|
|
|
Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
|
|
(comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
|
|
@code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
|
|
Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
|
|
code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
|
|
translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
|
|
itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
|
|
@code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
|
|
hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
@group
|
|
(defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
|
|
"Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
|
|
(let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
|
|
org-table-last-alignment ""))
|
|
(params2
|
|
(list
|
|
:tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
|
|
:tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
|
|
:lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
|
|
:efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
|
|
(orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
|
|
@end group
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
|
|
@var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
|
|
(variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
|
|
ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
|
|
would like to use the La@TeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
|
|
be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
|
|
overrule the default with
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
|
|
analogy with the La@TeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
|
|
directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
|
|
with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
|
|
started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
|
|
separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
|
|
a single line!):
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
|
|
:lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Please check the documentation string of the function
|
|
@code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
|
|
that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
|
|
@code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
|
|
using the generic function.
|
|
|
|
Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
|
|
things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
|
|
two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
|
|
line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
|
|
argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
|
|
@samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
|
|
containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
|
|
translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
|
|
others can benefit from your work.
|
|
|
|
@node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
|
|
@subsection Radio lists
|
|
@cindex radio lists
|
|
@cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
|
|
|
|
Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way than sending and
|
|
receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
|
|
insert radio lists templates in HTML, La@TeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
|
|
@code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
|
|
|
|
Here are the differences with radio tables:
|
|
|
|
@itemize @minus
|
|
@item
|
|
Orgstruct mode must be active.
|
|
@item
|
|
Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
|
|
@item
|
|
The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
|
|
parameters.
|
|
@item
|
|
@kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
Here is a La@TeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
|
|
La@TeX{} file:
|
|
|
|
@cindex #+ORGLST
|
|
@example
|
|
% BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
|
|
% END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
|
|
\begin@{comment@}
|
|
#+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
|
|
- a new house
|
|
- a new computer
|
|
+ a new keyboard
|
|
+ a new mouse
|
|
- a new life
|
|
\end@{comment@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
|
|
La@TeX{} list between the two marker lines.
|
|
|
|
@node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
|
|
@section Dynamic blocks
|
|
@cindex dynamic blocks
|
|
|
|
Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
|
|
specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
|
|
A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
|
|
command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
|
|
|
|
Dynamic block are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
|
|
to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
|
|
the content of the block.
|
|
|
|
#+BEGIN:dynamic block
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
|
|
|
|
#+END:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
|
|
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex C-c C-x C-u
|
|
@item C-c C-x C-u
|
|
Update dynamic block at point.
|
|
@kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
|
|
@item C-u C-c C-x C-u
|
|
Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
|
|
END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
|
|
writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
|
|
to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
|
|
extra parameter @code{:content}.
|
|
|
|
For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
|
|
@code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
|
|
with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
|
|
of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
|
|
run:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
|
|
|
|
#+END:
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
|
|
(let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
|
|
(insert "Last block update at: "
|
|
(format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
|
|
you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
|
|
example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
|
|
written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
|
|
@code{org-mode}.
|
|
|
|
@node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
|
|
@section Special agenda views
|
|
@cindex agenda views, user-defined
|
|
|
|
Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the
|
|
selection made by any of the agenda views. You may specify a function
|
|
that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part
|
|
of the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped.
|
|
|
|
Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
|
|
tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
|
|
marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
|
|
PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
|
|
PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
|
|
the subtree belonging to the project line.
|
|
|
|
To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
|
|
the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
|
|
indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
|
|
tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
|
|
search should continue from there.
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
|
|
"Skip trees that are not waiting"
|
|
(let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
|
|
(if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
|
|
nil ; tag found, do not skip
|
|
subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
|
|
like this:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(org-add-agenda-custom-command
|
|
'("b" todo "PROJECT"
|
|
((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
|
|
(org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
|
|
Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
|
|
meaningful header in the agenda view.
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-odd-levels-only
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-skip-function
|
|
A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
|
|
entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
|
|
your custom search function, simply do a search for
|
|
@samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
|
|
level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
|
|
stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
|
|
you really want to have.
|
|
|
|
You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
|
|
particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
|
|
and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
|
|
|
|
@table @code
|
|
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
|
|
Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
|
|
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
|
|
Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
|
|
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
|
|
Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
|
|
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
|
|
Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
|
|
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
|
|
Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
|
|
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
|
|
Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
|
|
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
|
|
Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
|
|
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
|
|
Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
|
|
@item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
|
|
Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
|
|
@item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
|
|
Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
|
|
like this, even without defining a special function:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(org-add-agenda-custom-command
|
|
'("b" todo "PROJECT"
|
|
((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
|
|
'regexp ":waiting:"))
|
|
(org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
|
|
@section Extracting agenda information
|
|
@cindex agenda, pipe
|
|
@cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
|
|
Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
|
|
line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
|
|
directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
|
|
processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
|
|
@code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
|
|
ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
|
|
If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
|
|
you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
|
|
key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
|
|
current TODO list, you could use
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
|
|
tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
|
|
(all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
|
|
@samp{NewYork}), you could use
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
|
|
-eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
|
|
-eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
|
|
org-agenda-ndays 30 \
|
|
org-agenda-include-diary nil \
|
|
org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
|
|
| lpr
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
|
|
@file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
|
|
|
|
If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
|
|
can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
|
|
list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
|
|
contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
|
|
are:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
category @r{The category of the item}
|
|
head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
|
|
type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
|
|
todo @r{selected in TODO match}
|
|
tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
|
|
diary @r{imported from diary}
|
|
deadline @r{a deadline}
|
|
scheduled @r{scheduled}
|
|
timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
|
|
closed @r{entry was closed on date}
|
|
upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
|
|
past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
|
|
block @r{entry has date block including date}
|
|
todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
|
|
tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
|
|
date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
|
|
time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
|
|
extra @r{String with extra planning info}
|
|
priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
|
|
priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@noindent
|
|
Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
|
|
led to the selection of the item.
|
|
|
|
A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
|
|
For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
|
|
Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
#!/usr/bin/perl
|
|
|
|
# define the Emacs command to run
|
|
$cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
|
|
|
|
# run it and capture the output
|
|
$agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
|
|
|
|
# loop over all lines
|
|
foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
|
|
# get the individual values
|
|
($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
|
|
$priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
|
|
# process and print
|
|
print "[ ] $head\n";
|
|
@}
|
|
@end example
|
|
|
|
@node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
|
|
@section Using the property API
|
|
@cindex API, for properties
|
|
@cindex properties, API
|
|
|
|
Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
|
|
properties.
|
|
|
|
@defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
|
|
Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
|
|
This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
|
|
scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
|
|
entry. The return value is an alist, keys may occur multiple times
|
|
if the property key was used several times.@*
|
|
POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
|
|
If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
|
|
`special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
@vindex org-use-property-inheritance
|
|
@defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
|
|
Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
|
|
this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
|
|
is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
|
|
higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
|
|
@code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
|
|
@code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-entry-delete pom property
|
|
Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-entry-put pom property value
|
|
Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
|
|
Get all property keys in the current buffer.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-insert-property-drawer
|
|
Insert a property drawer at point.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
|
|
Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
|
|
strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
|
|
Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
|
|
values and return the values as a list of strings.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
|
|
Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
|
|
values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
|
|
Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
|
|
values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
|
|
Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
|
|
values and check if VALUE is in this list.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
|
|
Hook for functions supplying allowed values for specific.
|
|
The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
|
|
return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
|
|
the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
|
|
to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
|
|
responsible for this property.
|
|
@end defopt
|
|
|
|
@node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
|
|
@section Using the mapping API
|
|
@cindex API, for mapping
|
|
@cindex mapping entries, API
|
|
|
|
Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
|
|
certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
|
|
views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
|
|
functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
|
|
is:
|
|
|
|
@defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
|
|
Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
|
|
|
|
FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
|
|
arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
|
|
The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
|
|
returned as a list.
|
|
|
|
The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
|
|
does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
|
|
moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
|
|
processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
|
|
circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
|
|
if you have removed (e.g. archived) the current (sub)tree it could
|
|
mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
|
|
can specify the position from where search should continue by making
|
|
FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
|
|
position.
|
|
|
|
MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
|
|
Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
|
|
the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
|
|
visited by the iteration.
|
|
|
|
SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
|
|
|
|
@example
|
|
nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
|
|
tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
|
|
file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
|
|
file-with-archives
|
|
@r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
|
|
agenda @r{all agenda files}
|
|
agenda-with-archives
|
|
@r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
|
|
(file1 file2 ...)
|
|
@r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@noindent
|
|
The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
|
|
the scanner. The following items can be given here:
|
|
|
|
@vindex org-agenda-skip-function
|
|
@example
|
|
archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
|
|
comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
|
|
function or Lisp form
|
|
@r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
|
|
@r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
|
|
@r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
|
|
@r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
|
|
@end example
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
|
|
It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
|
|
information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
|
|
Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
|
|
|
|
@defun org-todo &optional arg
|
|
Change the TODO state of the entry, see the docstring of the functions for
|
|
the many possible values for the argument ARG.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-priority &optional action
|
|
Change the priority of the entry, see the docstring of this function for the
|
|
possible values for ACTION.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
|
|
Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
|
|
or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-promote
|
|
Promote the current entry.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
@defun org-demote
|
|
Demote the current entry.
|
|
@end defun
|
|
|
|
Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
|
|
a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
|
|
Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(org-map-entries
|
|
'(org-todo "UPCOMING")
|
|
"+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
|
|
@code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
@node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
|
|
@appendix MobileOrg
|
|
@cindex iPhone
|
|
@cindex MobileOrg
|
|
|
|
@uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, MobileOrg} is an application for the
|
|
@i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
|
|
@i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org-mode
|
|
system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It does also allow you to record
|
|
changes to existing entries. Android users should check out
|
|
@uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
|
|
by Matt Jones.
|
|
|
|
This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
|
|
format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
|
|
captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
|
|
|
|
For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
|
|
customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
|
|
cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
|
|
part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
|
|
in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
|
|
@i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
|
|
(@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
|
|
|
|
@menu
|
|
* Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
|
|
* Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
|
|
* Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
|
|
@end menu
|
|
|
|
@node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
|
|
@section Setting up the staging area
|
|
|
|
MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through directory on a
|
|
server@footnote{If you are using a public server, you might prefer to encrypt
|
|
the files on the server. This can be done with Org-mode 6.35 and, hopefully,
|
|
with MobileOrg 1.4 (please check before trying to use this). On the Emacs
|
|
side, configure the variables @code{org-mobile-use-encryption} and
|
|
@code{org-mobile-encryption-password}.}. The easiest way to create that
|
|
directory is to use a free @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com}
|
|
account@footnote{If you cannot use Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg
|
|
does not support it, you can use a webdav server. For more information,
|
|
check out the the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
|
|
@uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.php#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
|
|
When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
|
|
@i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
|
|
Emacs about it:
|
|
|
|
@lisp
|
|
(setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
|
|
@end lisp
|
|
|
|
Org-mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
|
|
and to read captured notes from there.
|
|
|
|
@node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
|
|
@section Pushing to MobileOrg
|
|
|
|
This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
|
|
to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
|
|
all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
|
|
can be included by customizing @code{org-mobiles-files}. File names will be
|
|
staged with path relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
|
|
inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
|
|
@file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
|
|
user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force (see the
|
|
variable @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items}) ID properties on all
|
|
referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely
|
|
identified if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action.}. Finally, Org
|
|
writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other files.
|
|
@i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then downloads all
|
|
agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download, MobileOrg will
|
|
only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically in the file
|
|
@file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
|
|
|
|
@node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
|
|
@section Pulling from MobileOrg
|
|
|
|
When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
|
|
files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
|
|
and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
|
|
a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
|
|
and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
|
|
|
|
@enumerate
|
|
@item
|
|
Org moves all entries found in
|
|
@file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
|
|
operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
|
|
@code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
|
|
will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
|
|
@item
|
|
After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
|
|
@i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
|
|
interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
|
|
text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
|
|
action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
|
|
again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
|
|
pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
|
|
message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
|
|
@item
|
|
Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
|
|
should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
|
|
If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
|
|
will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
|
|
agenda line.
|
|
@table @kbd
|
|
@kindex ?
|
|
@item ?
|
|
Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
|
|
another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
|
|
z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
|
|
Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
|
|
@code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
|
|
in a property). In this way you indicate, that the intended processing for
|
|
this flagged entry is finished.
|
|
@end table
|
|
@end enumerate
|
|
|
|
@kindex C-c a ?
|
|
If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
|
|
return to this agenda view using @kbd{C-c a ?}. Note, however, that there is
|
|
a subtle difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x
|
|
org-mobile-pull @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been
|
|
addressed by the last pull. This might include a file that is not currently
|
|
in your list of agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate
|
|
the view, only the current agenda files will be searched.
|
|
|
|
@node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
|
|
@appendix History and acknowledgments
|
|
@cindex acknowledgments
|
|
@cindex history
|
|
@cindex thanks
|
|
|
|
Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
|
|
Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
|
|
Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
|
|
different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
|
|
parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
|
|
when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
|
|
tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
|
|
cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
|
|
package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
|
|
@file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
|
|
the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
|
|
@emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
|
|
still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
|
|
and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
|
|
functionality directly into a notes file.
|
|
|
|
Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
|
|
@email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
|
|
reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
|
|
Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
|
|
trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
|
|
in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
|
|
complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
|
|
let me know.
|
|
|
|
Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
|
|
|
|
@table @i
|
|
@item Bastien Guerry
|
|
Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
|
|
integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX exporter and the plain
|
|
list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
|
|
co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
|
|
invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors
|
|
hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
|
|
@item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
|
|
Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
|
|
Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
|
|
programming and reproducible research.
|
|
@item John Wiegley
|
|
John has also contributed a number of great ideas and patches
|
|
directly to Org, including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}),
|
|
integration with Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical
|
|
dependencies of TODO items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and
|
|
encryption (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an
|
|
extended copy of his great @file{remember.el}.
|
|
@item Sebastian Rose
|
|
Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
|
|
of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
|
|
higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
|
|
webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
|
|
single-key navigation.
|
|
@end table
|
|
|
|
@noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
|
|
know what I am missing here!
|
|
|
|
@itemize @bullet
|
|
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
|
|
Org-mode website.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
|
|
for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
|
|
specified time.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
|
|
calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
|
|
@file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
|
|
came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
|
|
them.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
|
|
inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
|
|
asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
|
|
the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format,
|
|
patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and inspired the agenda.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
|
|
HTML agendas.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
|
|
around a match in a hidden outline tree.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
|
|
task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
|
|
been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
|
|
patches.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
|
|
folded entries, and column view for properties.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded La@TeX{} and tested it. He also
|
|
provided frequent feedback and some patches.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
|
|
invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
|
|
and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
|
|
small fixes and patches.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
|
|
basis.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
|
|
happy.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
|
|
and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
|
|
file links, and TAGS.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a perl program to create a text
|
|
version of the reference card.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
|
|
into Japanese.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
|
|
links, among other things.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
|
|
provided frequent feedback.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
|
|
into bundles of 20 for undo.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
|
|
control.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
|
|
also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
|
|
conflict with @file{allout.el}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
|
|
extensive patches.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
|
|
of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
|
|
other things.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
|
|
@item
|
|
Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
|
|
@file{organizer-mode.el}.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
|
|
examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
|
|
now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
|
|
subtrees.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
|
|
tweaks and features.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
|
|
extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
|
|
LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
|
|
with links transformation to Org syntax.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
|
|
chapter about publishing.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
|
|
Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
|
|
concept index for HTML export.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
|
|
in HTML output.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
|
|
keyword.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
|
|
system.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
|
|
linking to Gnus.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
|
|
work on a tty.
|
|
@item
|
|
@i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
|
|
and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
|
|
@end itemize
|
|
|
|
|
|
@node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
|
|
@unnumbered Concept index
|
|
|
|
@printindex cp
|
|
|
|
@node Key Index, Variable Index, Main Index, Top
|
|
@unnumbered Key index
|
|
|
|
@printindex ky
|
|
|
|
@node Variable Index, , Key Index, Top
|
|
@unnumbered Variable index
|
|
|
|
This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
|
|
mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
|
|
org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
|
|
|
|
@printindex vr
|
|
|
|
@bye
|
|
|
|
@ignore
|
|
arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
|
|
@end ignore
|
|
|
|
@c Local variables:
|
|
@c fill-column: 77
|
|
@c End:
|
|
|
|
|
|
@c LocalWords: webdavhost pre
|